]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
* config/pdp11/pdp11.md (*and<mode>): Rename to *bic<mode>.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050
JR
1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
94@node Driver
95@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
96@cindex driver
97@cindex controlling the compilation driver
98
99@c prevent bad page break with this line
100You can control the compilation driver.
101
102@defmac SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{char})
103A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{char}}
104takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
105option takes--zero, for many options.
106
107By default, this macro is defined as
108@code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
109properly. You need not define @code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
110wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
111should call @code{DEFAULT_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
112additional options.
113@end defmac
114
115@defmac WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG (@var{name})
116A C expression which determines whether the option @option{-@var{name}}
117takes arguments. The value should be the number of arguments that
118option takes--zero, for many options. This macro rather than
119@code{SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} is used for multi-character option names.
120
121By default, this macro is defined as
122@code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG}, which handles the standard options
123properly. You need not define @code{WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} unless you
124wish to add additional options which take arguments. Any redefinition
125should call @code{DEFAULT_WORD_SWITCH_TAKES_ARG} and then check for
126additional options.
127@end defmac
128
38f8b050
JR
129@defmac TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE
130If defined, a list of pairs of strings, the first of which is a
131potential command line target to the @file{gcc} driver program, and the
132second of which is a space-separated (tabs and other whitespace are not
133supported) list of options with which to replace the first option. The
134target defining this list is responsible for assuring that the results
135are valid. Replacement options may not be the @code{--opt} style, they
136must be the @code{-opt} style. It is the intention of this macro to
137provide a mechanism for substitution that affects the multilibs chosen,
138such as one option that enables many options, some of which select
139multilibs. Example nonsensical definition, where @option{-malt-abi},
140@option{-EB}, and @option{-mspoo} cause different multilibs to be chosen:
141
142@smallexample
143#define TARGET_OPTION_TRANSLATE_TABLE \
144@{ "-fast", "-march=fast-foo -malt-abi -I/usr/fast-foo" @}, \
145@{ "-compat", "-EB -malign=4 -mspoo" @}
146@end smallexample
147@end defmac
148
149@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
150A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
151initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
152
153The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
154default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
155choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
156applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
157options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
158using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
159
160This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
161options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
162that the other specs are easier to write.
163
164Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
165@end defmac
166
167@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
168A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
169@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
170for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
171outermost pair of surrounding braces.
172
173The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
174the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
175to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
176@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
177everywhere it occurs.
178
179The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
180default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
181the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184@end defmac
185
186@defmac CPP_SPEC
187A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
188pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
189give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
190
191Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
192@end defmac
193
194@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
195This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
196than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
197@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
198@end defmac
199
200@defmac CC1_SPEC
201A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
202pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
203front ends.
204It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
205for GCC to pass to front ends.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
211A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
212pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
213give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
214
215Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
216Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
217@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
218CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
219@end defmac
220
221@defmac ASM_SPEC
222A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
223pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
224you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
225See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
226
227Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
228@end defmac
229
230@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
231A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
232run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
233Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
234an example of this.
235
236Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
237@end defmac
238
239@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
240Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
241an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
242read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
243output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
244@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
245
246If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
247standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
248cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
249see @file{mips.h} for instance.
250@end defmac
251
252@defmac LINK_SPEC
253A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
254pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
255give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
256
257Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
258@end defmac
259
260@defmac LIB_SPEC
261Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
262between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
263command given to the linker.
264
265If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
266loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
267@end defmac
268
269@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
270Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
271how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
272linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
273the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
274
275If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
276passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
277@end defmac
278
279@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
280By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
281@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
282instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
283depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
284@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
285targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
286@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
287driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
288line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
289@end defmac
290
291@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
292A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
293mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
294generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
295static exception handler library, when linking without any of
296@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
297@end defmac
298
299@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
300If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
301When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
302the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
303@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
304@end defmac
305
306@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
307Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
308difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
309the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
310
311If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
312standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
313@end defmac
314
315@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
316Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
317difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
318the very end of the command given to the linker.
319
320Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
321@end defmac
322
323@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
324GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
325However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
326models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
327@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
328blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
329default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
330@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
331@end defmac
332
333@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
334Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
335configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
336et al, within sysroot+suffix.
337@end defmac
338
339@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
340Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
341GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
342updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
343usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
344@end defmac
345
346@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
347Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
348@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
349@code{CC1_SPEC}.
350
351The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
352containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
353string constant that provides the specification.
354
355Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
356
357@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
358related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
359to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
360these definitions.
361
362For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
363define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
364used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
365used.
366
367The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
368
369@smallexample
370#define EXTRA_SPECS \
371 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
372
373#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
374@end smallexample
375
376The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
377@smallexample
378#undef CPP_SPEC
379#define CPP_SPEC \
380"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
381%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
382%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
383%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
384
385#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
386#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
387@end smallexample
388
389while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
390@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
391
392@smallexample
393#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
394#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
395@end smallexample
396@end defmac
397
398@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
399Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
400@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
401the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
405The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
406By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
407@end defmac
408
409@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
410A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
411linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
412change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
413define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
414line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
415the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
416@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
417@end defmac
418
419@defmac LINK_ELIMINATE_DUPLICATE_LDIRECTORIES
420A nonzero value causes @command{collect2} to remove duplicate @option{-L@var{directory}} search
421directories from linking commands. Do not give it a nonzero value if
422removing duplicate search directories changes the linker's semantics.
423@end defmac
424
425@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
426Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
427string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
428target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
429@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
430
431Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
432the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
433@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
434@xref{Target Fragment}.
435@end defmac
436
437@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
438Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
439a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
440indicates an absolute file name.
441@end defmac
442
443@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
444If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
445@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
446when the compiler is built as a cross
447compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
448to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
449@end defmac
450
451@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
452Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
453standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
454try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
455@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
456is built as a cross compiler.
457@end defmac
458
459@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
460Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
461standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
462when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
463@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
464is built as a cross compiler.
465@end defmac
466
467@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
468Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
469standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
470default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
471@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
472is built as a cross compiler.
473@end defmac
474
475@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
476If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
477standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
478compiler is built as a cross compiler.
479@end defmac
480
481@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
482If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
483standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
484cross compiler.
485@end defmac
486
487@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
488Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
489variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
490loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
491initialize the necessary environment variables.
492@end defmac
493
494@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
495Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
496standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
497try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
498comes before @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
499
500Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
501replacement.
502@end defmac
503
504@defmac SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR
505Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to specify a
506system-specific directory to search for header files before the standard
507directory. @code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR} comes before
508@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR} in the search order.
509
510Cross compilers do not use this macro and do not search the directory
511specified.
512@end defmac
513
514@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR
515Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
516standard choice of @file{/usr/include} as the default prefix to
517try when searching for header files.
518
519Cross compilers ignore this macro and do not search either
520@file{/usr/include} or its replacement.
521@end defmac
522
523@defmac STANDARD_INCLUDE_COMPONENT
524The ``component'' corresponding to @code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}.
525See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
526If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
527@end defmac
528
529@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
530Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
531for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
532usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
533@code{SYSTEM_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
534@code{STANDARD_INCLUDE_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
535and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
536and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
537@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
538
539The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
540Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
541string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
542for C++-only directories,
543and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
544wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
545the array with a null element.
546
547The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
548if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
549or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
550operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
551
552For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
553
554@smallexample
555#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
556@{ \
557 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
558 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
559 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
560 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
561 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
562@}
563@end smallexample
564@end defmac
565
566Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
567
568@enumerate
569@item
570Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
571
572@item
573The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
574is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
575@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
576
577@item
578The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
579
580@item
581The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
582in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
583
584@item
585The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
586
587@item
588The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
589
590@item
591The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
592compiler.
593@end enumerate
594
595Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
596
597@enumerate
598@item
599Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
600
601@item
602The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
603value based on the installed toolchain location.
604
605@item
606The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
607(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
608
609@item
610The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
611in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
612
613@item
614The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
615
616@item
617The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
618compiler.
619
620@item
621The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
622native compiler, or we have a target system root.
623
624@item
625The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
626native compiler, or we have a target system root.
627
628@item
629The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
630If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
631the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
632
633@item
634The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
635compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
636@file{/lib/}.
637
638@item
639The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
640compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
641@file{/usr/lib/}.
642@end enumerate
643
644@node Run-time Target
645@section Run-time Target Specification
646@cindex run-time target specification
647@cindex predefined macros
648@cindex target specifications
649
650@c prevent bad page break with this line
651Here are run-time target specifications.
652
653@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
654This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
655built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
656the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
657@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
658calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
659finished command line option processing your code can use those
660results freely.
661
662@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
663command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
664the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
665accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
666
667@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
668object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
669@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
670defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
671with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
672only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
673example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
674and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
675@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
676defines only @code{_ABI64}.
677
678You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
679@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
680or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
681assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
682macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
683to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
684variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
685@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
686preprocessing.
687@end defmac
688
689@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
690Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
691and is used for the target operating system instead.
692@end defmac
693
694@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
695Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
696and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
697macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
698it yourself.
699@end defmac
700
701@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
702This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
703any target-specific headers.
704@end deftypevar
705
706@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
707This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
708Its default setting is 0.
709@end deftypevr
710
711@cindex optional hardware or system features
712@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
713
714@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
715This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
716target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
717(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
718processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
719definition does nothing but return true.
720
721@var{code} specifies the @code{OPT_@var{name}} enumeration value
722associated with the selected option; @var{name} is just a rendering of
723the option name in which non-alphanumeric characters are replaced by
724underscores. @var{arg} specifies the string argument and is null if
725no argument was given. If the option is flagged as a @code{UInteger}
726(@pxref{Option properties}), @var{value} is the numeric value of the
727argument. Otherwise @var{value} is 1 if the positive form of the
728option was used and 0 if the ``no-'' form was.
729@end deftypefn
730
731@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
732This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
733target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
734definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
735option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
736valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
737default definition does nothing but return false.
738
739In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
740options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
741only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
742should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
743@end deftypefn
744
26705988
IS
745@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING
746
38f8b050
JR
747@defmac TARGET_VERSION
748This macro is a C statement to print on @code{stderr} a string
749describing the particular machine description choice. Every machine
750description should define @code{TARGET_VERSION}. For example:
751
752@smallexample
753#ifdef MOTOROLA
754#define TARGET_VERSION \
755 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, Motorola syntax)");
756#else
757#define TARGET_VERSION \
758 fprintf (stderr, " (68k, MIT syntax)");
759#endif
760@end smallexample
761@end defmac
762
38f8b050
JR
763@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
764This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
765but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
766pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
767attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
768when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
769actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
770@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
771@end deftypefn
772
773@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
774This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
775but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
776language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
777used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
778frontends.
779@end defmac
780
3020190e 781@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 782Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
783various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
784options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
785options are processed once
38f8b050 786just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e
JM
787of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
788options passed explicily.
38f8b050 789
3020190e 790This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
791options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
792@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 793@end deftypevr
38f8b050 794
7e4aae92
JM
795@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
796
128dc8e2
JM
797@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
798
38f8b050
JR
799@hook TARGET_HELP
800This hook is called in response to the user invoking
801@option{--target-help} on the command line. It gives the target a
802chance to display extra information on the target specific command
803line options found in its @file{.opt} file.
804@end deftypefn
805
3bd36029
RS
806@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
807Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
808during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
809the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
810can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
811and @code{nomips16} attributes.
812
813Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
814registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
815operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
816in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
817significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
818for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
819switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
820
821Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
822is 0.
823@end defmac
824
38f8b050
JR
825@node Per-Function Data
826@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
827@cindex per-function data
828@cindex data structures
829
830If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
831provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
832using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
833nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
834when another one comes along.
835
836GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
837contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
838structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
839@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
840to their own specific data.
841
842If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
843@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
844This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
845@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
846
847One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
848RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
849RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
850function, for level 0.
851
852Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
853all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
854function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
855stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
856stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
857@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
858the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
859single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
860longer supported.
861
862@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
863Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
864is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
865The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
866function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
867@end defmac
868
869@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
870If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
871function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
872target to perform any target specific initialization of the
873@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
874used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
875
876@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
877Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
878GC allocation, including the structure itself.
879@end deftypevar
880
881@node Storage Layout
882@section Storage Layout
883@cindex storage layout
884
885Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
886alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
887expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
888@xref{Run-time Target}.
889
890@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
891Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
892byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
893This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
894bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
895be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
896macro need not be a constant.
897
898This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
899bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
900@end defmac
901
902@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
903Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
904word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
905@end defmac
906
907@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
908Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
909most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
910memory locations and registers; GCC fundamentally assumes that the
911order of words in memory is the same as the order in registers. This
912macro need not be a constant.
913@end defmac
914
38f8b050
JR
915@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
916Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
917@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
918containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
919have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
920
921You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
922multi-word integers.
923@end defmac
924
925@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
926Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
927unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
928@end defmac
929
930@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
931Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
932is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
933@end defmac
934
935@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
936Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
937@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
938largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
939@end defmac
940
941@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
942Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
943register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
944@end defmac
945
946@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
947Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
948@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
949smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
950@end defmac
951
38f8b050
JR
952@defmac POINTER_SIZE
953Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
954width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
955you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
956a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
957@end defmac
958
959@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
960A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
961@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
962greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
963should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
964is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
965@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
966
967You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
968and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
969@end defmac
970
971@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
972A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
973is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
974stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
975scalar type.
976
977On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
978register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
979@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
980cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
981floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
982counterparts.
983
984For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
985However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
986either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
987the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
988sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
989@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
990
991Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
992@end defmac
993
994@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
995Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
996function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
997and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
998change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
999pointer} types.
1000
1001@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
1002return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
1003@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
1004If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
1005which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
1006then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
1007the signedness may be different.
1008
1009The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
1010also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
1011if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
1012@end deftypefn
1013
1014@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
1015Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
1016bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
1017regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
1018size of an integer.
1019@end defmac
1020
1021@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
1022Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
1023stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
1024desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1025if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1026this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1027@end defmac
1028
1029@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1030Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1031stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1032is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1033macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1034@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1035@end defmac
1036
1037@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1038Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1039from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1040to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1041@end defmac
1042
1043@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1044Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1045@end defmac
1046
1047@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1048Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1049bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1050just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1051@end defmac
1052
1053@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1054Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1055provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1056@end defmac
1057
1058@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1059Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1060not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1061@end defmac
1062
1063@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1064If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1065object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1066nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1067on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1068@end defmac
1069
1070@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1071Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1072machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1073structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1074by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1075@end defmac
1076
1077@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1078An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1079alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1080@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1081alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1082field alignment has not been set by the
1083@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1084@end defmac
1085
1086@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1087Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1088to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1089
1090If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1091
1092@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1093@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1094@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1095@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1096@end defmac
1097
1098@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1099Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1100Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1101@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1102the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1103
1104On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1105the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1106a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1107On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1108@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1109@end defmac
1110
1111@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1112If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1113the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1114the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1115macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1116
1117If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1118
1119@findex strcpy
1120One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1121make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1122arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1123constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1124@end defmac
1125
1126@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1127If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1128that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1129@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1130have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1131align the object.
1132
1133If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1134
1135The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1136constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1137constants can be done inline.
1138@end defmac
1139
1140@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1141If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1142the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1143the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1144macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1145
1146If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1147
1148One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1149make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1150@end defmac
1151
1152@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1153If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1154@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1155and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1156have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1157align the slot.
1158
1159If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1160@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1161be used.
1162
1163This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1164of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1165@end defmac
1166
1167@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1168If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1169variable @var{decl}.
1170
1171If this macro is not defined, then
1172@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1173is used.
1174
1175One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1176make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1177@end defmac
1178
1179@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1180If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1181for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1182@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1183
1184If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1185@end defmac
1186
1187@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1188Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1189empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1190
1191If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1192@end defmac
1193
1194@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1195Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1196Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1197
1198If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1199@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1200@end defmac
1201
1202@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1203Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1204if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1205go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1206@end defmac
1207
1208@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1209Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1210alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1211
1212The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1213@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1214structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1215that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1216that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1217
1218Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1219@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1220four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1221not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1222
1223An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1224structure.
1225
1226If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1227a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1228
1229Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1230bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1231support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1232@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1233
1234The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1235@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1236Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1237
1238Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1239@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1240@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1241
1242If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1243bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1244what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1245
1246@smallexample
1247struct foo1
1248@{
1249 char x;
1250 char :0;
1251 char y;
1252@};
1253
1254struct foo2
1255@{
1256 char x;
1257 int :0;
1258 char y;
1259@};
1260
1261main ()
1262@{
1263 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1264 sizeof (struct foo1));
1265 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1266 sizeof (struct foo2));
1267 exit (0);
1268@}
1269@end smallexample
1270
1271If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1272get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1273@end defmac
1274
1275@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1276Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1277to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1278@end defmac
1279
1280@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1281When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1282whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1283structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1284the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1285@end deftypefn
1286
1287@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1288This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1289should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1290these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1291
1292The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1293@end deftypefn
1294
1295@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1296Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1297@code{BLKMODE}.
1298
1299If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1300mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1301case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1302retain the field's mode.
1303
1304Normally, this is not needed.
1305@end defmac
1306
1307@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1308Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1309by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1310way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1311@var{specified}.
1312
1313The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1314the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1315@end defmac
1316
1317@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1318An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1319machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1320this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1321appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1322(DImode)} is assumed.
1323@end defmac
1324
1325@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1326If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1327specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1328@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1329@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1330@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1331having its mode specified.
1332
1333You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1334would most commonly define this macro if the
1335@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
133664-bit mode.
1337@end defmac
1338
1339@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1340If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1341specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1342@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1343
1344You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1345You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1346pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1347@end defmac
1348
1349@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1350This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1351of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1352@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1353targets.
1354@end deftypefn
1355
1356@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1357This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1358of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1359@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1360targets.
1361@end deftypefn
1362
1363@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1364Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1365The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1366@end deftypefn
1367
1368@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1369If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1370mode is towards zero.
1371
1372Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1373floating-point arithmetic.
1374
1375Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1376@end defmac
1377
1378@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1379This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1380bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1381exponent for normal numbers instead.
1382
1383Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1384floating-point arithmetic.
1385
1386The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1387@end defmac
1388
1389@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1390This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1391@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1392Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1393unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1394different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1395alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1396bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1397the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1398(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1399another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1400other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1401
1402When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1403of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1404bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1405and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1406chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1407size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1408alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1409
1410If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1411the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1412used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1413precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1414may affect its placement.
1415@end deftypefn
1416
1417@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1418Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1419@end deftypefn
1420
1421@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1422Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1423@end deftypefn
1424
1425@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1426This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1427to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1428For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1429for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1430registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1431usage.
1432@end deftypefn
1433
1434@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1435This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1436that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1437@end deftypefn
1438
1439@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1440If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1441uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1442to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1443mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1444the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1445not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1446for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1447return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1448string constant.
1449
1450Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1451qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1452fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1453is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1454length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1455ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1456@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1457@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1458code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1459@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1460codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1461spaces in your string.
1462
1463This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1464name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1465can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1466before mangling.
1467
1468The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1469appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1470types.
1471@end deftypefn
1472
1473@node Type Layout
1474@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1475
1476These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1477basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1478the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1479languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1480
1481@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1482A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1483target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1484@end defmac
1485
1486@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1487A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1488target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1489(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1490unit.)
1491@end defmac
1492
1493@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1494A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1495target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1496@end defmac
1497
1498@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1499On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1500@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1501that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1502the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1503value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1504@end defmac
1505
1506@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1507A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1508target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1509words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1510macro must be at least 64.
1511@end defmac
1512
1513@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1514A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1515target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1516@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1517@end defmac
1518
1519@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1520A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1521C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1522this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1523@end defmac
1524
1525@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1526A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1527target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1528@end defmac
1529
1530@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1532target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1533words.
1534@end defmac
1535
1536@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1537A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1538the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1539words.
1540@end defmac
1541
1542@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1543A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1544the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1546@end defmac
1547
1548@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1549A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1550the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1552@end defmac
1553
1554@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1555A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1556the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1558@end defmac
1559
1560@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1561A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1562the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1563@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1564@end defmac
1565
1566@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1567A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1568the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1569@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1570@end defmac
1571
1572@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1573A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1574the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1575@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1576@end defmac
1577
1578@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1579A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1580the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1581@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1582@end defmac
1583
1584@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1585A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1586the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1587@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1588@end defmac
1589
1590@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1591Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1592if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1593@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1594default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1595@end defmac
1596
1597@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1598Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1599@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1600@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1601anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1602or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1603otherwise it is 0.
1604@end defmac
1605
1606@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1607Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1608@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1609anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1610is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1611@end defmac
1612
1613@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1614Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1615@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1616anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1617is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1618@end defmac
1619
1620@defmac SF_SIZE
1621@defmacx DF_SIZE
1622@defmacx XF_SIZE
1623@defmacx TF_SIZE
1624Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1625@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1626if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1627@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1628for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1629@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1630@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1631@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1632@end defmac
1633
1634@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1635A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1636assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1637default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1638@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1639@end defmac
1640
1641@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1642A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1643supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1644value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1645If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1646is the default.
1647@end defmac
1648
1649@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1650An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1651@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1652always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1653and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1654@end defmac
1655
1656@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1657This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1658@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1659of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1660@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1661
1662The default is to return false.
1663@end deftypefn
1664
1665@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1666A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1667for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1668contents of the string.
1669
1670The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1671spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1672appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1673of the data type names defined in the function
1674@code{init_decl_processing} in the file @file{c-decl.c}. You may not
1675omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the compiler to
1676crash on startup.
1677
1678If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1679int"}.
1680@end defmac
1681
1682@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1683A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1684for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1685@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1686@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1687
1688If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1689@end defmac
1690
1691@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1692A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1693for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1694the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1695information.
1696
1697If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1698@end defmac
1699
1700@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1701A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1702characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1703@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1704@end defmac
1705
1706@defmac WINT_TYPE
1707A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1708use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1709@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1710contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1711information.
1712
1713If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1714@end defmac
1715
1716@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1717A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1718can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1719The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1720string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1721
1722If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1723@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1724much precision as @code{long long int}.
1725@end defmac
1726
1727@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1728A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1729can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1730type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1731of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1732
1733If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1734@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1735unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1736int}.
1737@end defmac
1738
1739@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1740@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1741@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1742@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1743@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1744@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1745@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1746@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1747@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1748@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1749@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1750@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1751@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1752@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1753@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1754@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1755@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1756@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1757@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1758@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1759@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1760@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1761@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1762@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1763@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1764@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1765@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1766C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1767@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1768@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1769@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1770@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1771@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1772@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1773@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1774@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1775@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1776
1777If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1778type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1779@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1780to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1781these macros are null pointers.
1782@end defmac
1783
1784@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1785The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1786that looks like:
1787
1788@smallexample
1789 struct @{
1790 union @{
1791 void (*fn)();
1792 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1793 @};
1794 ptrdiff_t delta;
1795 @};
1796@end smallexample
1797
1798@noindent
1799The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1800will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1801Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1802always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1803distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1804platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1805that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1806the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1807
1808GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1809this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1810However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1811set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1812bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1813address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1814architecture, you should define this macro to
1815@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1816
1817In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1818in which function addresses are always even, according to
1819@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1820@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1821@end defmac
1822
1823@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1824Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1825macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1826instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1827function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1828data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1829pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1830
1831If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1832of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1833@end defmac
1834
1835@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1836By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1837is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1838the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1839when special alignment is necessary. */
1840@end defmac
1841
1842@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1843There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1844zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1845specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1846of words in each data entry.
1847@end defmac
1848
1849@node Registers
1850@section Register Usage
1851@cindex register usage
1852
1853This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1854has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1855
1856The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1857done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1858on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1859For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1860For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1861
1862@menu
1863* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1864* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1865* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1866* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1867* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1868@end menu
1869
1870@node Register Basics
1871@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1872
1873@c prevent bad page break with this line
1874Registers have various characteristics.
1875
1876@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1877Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1878numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1879pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1880@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1881@end defmac
1882
1883@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1884@cindex fixed register
1885An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1886all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1887general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1888pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1889register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1890machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1891and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1892
1893This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1894commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1895register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1896
1897The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1898the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1899by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1900the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1901@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1902@end defmac
1903
1904@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1905@cindex call-used register
1906@cindex call-clobbered register
1907@cindex call-saved register
1908Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1909clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1910registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1911available for general allocation of values that must live across
1912function calls.
1913
1914If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1915automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1916exit, if the register is used within the function.
1917@end defmac
1918
1919@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1920@cindex call-used register
1921@cindex call-clobbered register
1922@cindex call-saved register
1923Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1924that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1925(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1926This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1927of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1928@end defmac
1929
1930@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1931@cindex call-used register
1932@cindex call-clobbered register
1933@cindex call-saved register
1934A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1935value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1936call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1937macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1938preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1939@end defmac
1940
1941@findex fixed_regs
1942@findex call_used_regs
1943@findex global_regs
1944@findex reg_names
1945@findex reg_class_contents
1946@defmac CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1947Zero or more C statements that may conditionally modify five variables
1948@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1949@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1950any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1951of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1952@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1953@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1954called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1955@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1956from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1957@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1958@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1959@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1960command options have been applied.
1961
1962You need not define this macro if it has no work to do.
1963
1964@cindex disabling certain registers
1965@cindex controlling register usage
1966If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1967flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1968@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1969registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1970the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1971to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1972is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1973
1974(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1975of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1976controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1977these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1978@end defmac
1979
1980@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1981Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1982expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1983corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1984function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1985outbound register.
1986@end defmac
1987
1988@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1989Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1990expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1991corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1992function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1993register.
1994@end defmac
1995
1996@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1997Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1998expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1999register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
2000need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
2001gotos.
2002@end defmac
2003
2004@defmac PC_REGNUM
2005If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2006register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2007@end defmac
2008
2009@node Allocation Order
2010@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2011@cindex order of register allocation
2012@cindex register allocation order
2013
2014@c prevent bad page break with this line
2015Registers are allocated in order.
2016
2017@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2018If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2019numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2020to use them (from most preferred to least).
2021
2022If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2023(all else being equal).
2024
2025One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2026registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2027instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2028machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2029the highest numbered allocable register first.
2030@end defmac
2031
2032@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2033A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2034hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2035
2036Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2037Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2038register; and so on.
2039
2040The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2041@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2042
2043On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2044@end defmac
2045
2046@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2047Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2048prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2049using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2050allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2051call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2052should be defined.
2053@end defmac
2054
2055@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2056In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2057Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2058If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2059based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2060be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2061value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2062to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2063
2064On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2065@end defmac
2066
2067@node Values in Registers
2068@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2069
2070This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2071(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2072consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2073
2074@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2075A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2076at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2077@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2078cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2079and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2080
2081On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2082definition of this macro is
2083
2084@smallexample
2085#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2086 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2087 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2088@end smallexample
2089@end defmac
2090
2091@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2092A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2093in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2094in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2095multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2096this mode by the number of registers returned by
2097@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2098
2099For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2100registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2101nonzero.
2102
2103This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2104@code{subreg_get_info}
2105would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2106represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2107@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2108registers and so not be representable.
2109@end defmac
2110
2111@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2112For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2113@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2114returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2115including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2116@end defmac
2117
2118@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2119Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2120of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2121should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2122used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2123happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2124floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2125@end defmac
2126
2127@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2128A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2129of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2130registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2131are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2132
2133@smallexample
2134#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2135@end smallexample
2136
2137You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2138because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2139
2140@cindex register pairs
2141On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2142register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2143odd register numbers for such modes.
2144
2145The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2146@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2147register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2148value into the register and back out not alter it.
2149
2150Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2151all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2152@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2153you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2154is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2155and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2156to be tieable.
2157
2158Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2159Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2160in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2161can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2162mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2163registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2164
2165On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2166modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2167registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2168non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2169@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2170floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2171normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2172unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2173register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2174
2175The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2176they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2177instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2178@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2179constraints for those instructions.
2180
2181On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2182so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2183register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2184floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2185be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2186@end defmac
2187
2188@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2189A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2190@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2191
2192One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2193another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2194handler.
2195
2196The default is always nonzero.
2197@end defmac
2198
2199@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2200A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2201@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2202
2203If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2204@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2205any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2206should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2207this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2208accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2209
2210You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2211possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2212allocation.
2213@end defmac
2214
2215@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2216This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2217@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2218
2219One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2220is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2221
2222The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2223@end deftypefn
2224
2225@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2226Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2227registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2228@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2229@end defmac
2230
2231@node Leaf Functions
2232@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2233
2234@cindex leaf functions
2235@cindex functions, leaf
2236On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2237more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2238means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2239are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2240normally arrive.
2241
2242The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2243other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2244registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2245function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2246handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2247functions''.
2248
2249GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2250suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2251registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2252accomplish this.
2253
2254@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2255Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2256contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2257function treatment.
2258
2259If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2260registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2261GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2262used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2263in this vector.
2264
2265Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2266the treatment of leaf functions.
2267@end defmac
2268
2269@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2270A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2271should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2272
2273If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2274function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2275will cause the compiler to abort.
2276
2277Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2278treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2279this.
2280@end defmac
2281
2282@findex current_function_is_leaf
2283@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2284@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2285@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2286specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2287which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2288set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2289compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2290@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2291functions which only use leaf registers.
2292@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2293that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2294@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2295@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2296@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2297
2298@node Stack Registers
2299@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2300
2301There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2302``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2303pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2304stack.
2305
2306Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2307they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2308support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2309point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2310stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2311@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2312with it, as well as defining these macros.
2313
2314@defmac STACK_REGS
2315Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2316@end defmac
2317
2318@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2319This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2320the machine has any stack-like registers.
2321@end defmac
2322
2323@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2324The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2325of the stack.
2326@end defmac
2327
2328@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2329The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2330the stack.
2331@end defmac
2332
2333@node Register Classes
2334@section Register Classes
2335@cindex register class definitions
2336@cindex class definitions, register
2337
2338On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2339For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2340certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2341restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2342
2343You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2344which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2345that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2346
2347@findex ALL_REGS
2348@findex NO_REGS
2349In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2350class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2351class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2352union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2353
2354@findex GENERAL_REGS
2355One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2356terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2357@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2358the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2359to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2360
2361Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2362then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2363
2364The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2365constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2366You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2367them in operand constraints.
2368
2369You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2370instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2371either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2372certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2373which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code.
2374
2375You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2376classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2377contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2378in their union.
2379
2380When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2381certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2382Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2383a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2384specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2385
2386Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2387instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2388each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2389mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2390single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2391this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2392instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2393single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2394@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2395
2396@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2397An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2398as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2399must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2400@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2401tells how many classes there are.
2402
2403Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2404the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2405in many of the tables described below.
2406@end deftp
2407
2408@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2409The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2410
2411@smallexample
2412#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2413@end smallexample
2414@end defmac
2415
2416@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2417An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2418constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2419@end defmac
2420
2421@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2422An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2423which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2424@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2425register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2426
2427When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2428Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2429several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2430for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2431In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2432registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2433so on.
2434@end defmac
2435
2436@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2437A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2438@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2439which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2440register.
2441@end defmac
2442
2443@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2444A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2445base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2446which is the register value plus a displacement.
2447@end defmac
2448
2449@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2450This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2451the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2452@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2453@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2454@end defmac
2455
2456@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2457A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2458base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2459register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2460addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2461@end defmac
2462
2463@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2464A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2465base register must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code} define the
2466context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is the code of
2467the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level of an
2468address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2469@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2470index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2471@end defmac
2472
2473@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2474A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2475index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2476address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2477added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2478@end defmac
2479
2480@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2481A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2482suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2483Like @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}, this macro should also
2484define a strict and a non-strict variant. Both variants behave
2485the same for hard register; for pseudos, the strict variant will
2486pass only those that have been allocated to a valid hard registers,
2487while the non-strict variant will pass all pseudos.
2488
2489@findex REG_OK_STRICT
2490Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this and
2491other macros define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
2492@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
2493that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
2494@end defmac
2495
2496@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2497A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2498that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2499@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2500reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2501you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2502@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2503addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2504@code{address_operand}.
2505
2506This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2507@end defmac
2508
2509@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2510A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2511use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2512memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2513pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2514define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2515than other base register uses.
2516
2517Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2518@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2519
2520This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2521@end defmac
2522
2523@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2524A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2525that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2526appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2527immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2528address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2529@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2530corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2531@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2532that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2533
2534This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2535@end defmac
2536
2537@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2538A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2539suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2540either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2541allocated such a hard register.
2542
2543The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2544the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2545two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2546labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2547labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2548may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2549looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2550only if neither labeling works.
2551
2552This macro also has strict and non-strict variants.
2553@end defmac
2554
fba42e24
AS
2555@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2556A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2557to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2558@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2559another, smaller class.
2560
2561The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2562
2563Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2564example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2565for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2566@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2567Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2568
2569One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2570@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2571loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2572force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2573immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2574instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2575register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2576@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2577into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2578@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2579of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2580
2581If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2582through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2583to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2584reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2585this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2586the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2587@end deftypefn
2588
38f8b050
JR
2589@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2590A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2591to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2592@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2593another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2594safe:
2595
2596@smallexample
2597#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2598@end smallexample
2599
2600Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2601example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2602for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2603@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2604Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2605
2606One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2607@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2608loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2609force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2610immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2611instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2612register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2613@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2614into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2615@code{LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2616of using @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2617
2618If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2619through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2620to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2621reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2622this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2623the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2624@end defmac
2625
2626@defmac PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2627Like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2628input reloads. If you don't define this macro, the default is to use
2629@var{class}, unchanged.
2630
2631You can also use @code{PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2632reload from using some alternatives, like @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2633@end defmac
2634
abd26bfb
AS
2635@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2636Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2637input reloads.
2638
2639The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2640argument.
2641
2642You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2643reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2644@end deftypefn
2645
38f8b050
JR
2646@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2647A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2648to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2649@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2650ordinarily be used.
2651
2652Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2653there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2654
2655The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2656smaller class.
2657
2658Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2659require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2660@end defmac
2661
2662@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2663Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2664from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2665@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2666from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2667term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2668directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2669register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2670destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2671source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2672reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2673and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2674intermediate register still holds the required value.
2675
2676Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2677allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2678register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2679address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2680when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2681as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2682that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2683describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2684these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2685of the scratch register(s).
2686
2687In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2688
2689For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2690and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2691@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2692hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2693needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2694
2695If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2696an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2697return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2698If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2699If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2700that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2701
2702If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2703perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2704closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2705required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2706copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2707
2708You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2709in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2710and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2711for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2712single-register-class
2713@c [later: or memory]
2714output constraint.
2715
2716When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2717hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2718register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2719have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2720
2721@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2722@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2723@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2724@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2725@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2726@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2727@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2728@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2729
2730
2731@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2732pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2733Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2734in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2735
2736Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2737currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2738to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2739
2740@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2741copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2742(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2743Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2744of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2745forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2746@end deftypefn
2747
2748@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2749@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2750@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2751These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2752@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2753
2754These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2755target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2756reload phase that it may
2757need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2758register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2759register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2760you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2761largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2762intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2763
2764If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2765intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2766was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2767class required. If the
2768requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2769@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2770macros identically.
2771
2772The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2773Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2774can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2775@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2776macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2777
2778If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2779intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2780@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2781(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2782implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2783@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2784register.
2785
2786These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2787register that
2788contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2789class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2790value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2791register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2792Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2793
2794@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2795pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2796Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2797in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2798
2799These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2800registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2801registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2802would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2803the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2804intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2805general registers.
2806@end defmac
2807
2808@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2809Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2810to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2811those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2812@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2813class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2814and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2815
2816Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2817@end defmac
2818
2819@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2820Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2821allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2822If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2823defined by this macro.
2824
2825Do not define this macro if you do not define
2826@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2827@end defmac
2828
2829@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2830When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2831registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2832hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2833load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2834same as that of @var{mode}.
2835
2836This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2837bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2838in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2839registers.
2840
2841However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2842the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2843differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2844widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2845suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2846details.
2847
2848Do not define this macro if you do not define
2849@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2850is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2851@end defmac
2852
07b8f0a8
AS
2853@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2854A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2855to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2856registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2857
2858The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2859has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2860default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2861if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2862hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2863@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2864@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2865register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2866you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2867the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2868allocation.
2869@end deftypefn
2870
38f8b050
JR
2871@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2872A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2873of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2874
2875This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2876the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2877should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2878@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2879
2880This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2881in the reload pass.
2882@end defmac
2883
2884@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2885If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2886a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2887
2888For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2889floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2890Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2891does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2892register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2893as below:
2894
2895@smallexample
2896#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2897 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2898 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2899@end smallexample
2900@end defmac
2901
2902@hook TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2903Return an array of cover classes for the Integrated Register Allocator
2904(@acronym{IRA}). Cover classes are a set of non-intersecting register
2905classes covering all hard registers used for register allocation
2906purposes. If a move between two registers in the same cover class is
2907possible, it should be cheaper than a load or store of the registers.
2908The array is terminated by a @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES} element.
2909
2910The order of cover classes in the array is important. If two classes
2911have the same cost of usage for a pseudo, the class occurred first in
2912the array is chosen for the pseudo.
2913
2914This hook is called once at compiler startup, after the command-line
2915options have been processed. It is then re-examined by every call to
2916@code{target_reinit}.
2917
2918The default implementation returns @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES}, if defined,
2919otherwise there is no default implementation. You must define either this
2920macro or @code{IRA_COVER_CLASSES} in order to use the integrated register
2921allocator with Chaitin-Briggs coloring. If the macro is not defined,
2922the only available coloring algorithm is Chow's priority coloring.
2923@end deftypefn
2924
2925@defmac IRA_COVER_CLASSES
2926See the documentation for @code{TARGET_IRA_COVER_CLASSES}.
2927@end defmac
2928
2929@node Old Constraints
2930@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2931@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2932@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2933
2934Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2935of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2936Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2937it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2938
2939@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2940For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2941@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2942constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2943you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2944constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2945DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2946to handle specially.
2947There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2948for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2949transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2950return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2951will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2952@end defmac
2953
2954@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2955A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2956letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2957value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2958the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2959corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2960to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2961@end defmac
2962
2963@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2964Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2965passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2966different variants.
2967@end defmac
2968
2969@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2970A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2971letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2972particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2973letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2974the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2975not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2976@var{value}.
2977@end defmac
2978
2979@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2980Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2981string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2982between different variants.
2983@end defmac
2984
2985@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2986A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2987letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2988(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2989
2990If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2991@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2992range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2993letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2994
2995@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2996@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2997or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2998between these kinds.
2999@end defmac
3000
3001@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3002Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
3003string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
3004between different variants.
3005@end defmac
3006
3007@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
3008A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3009letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
3010memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
3011elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
3012@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
3013may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
3014
3015If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
3016if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
3017constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
3018constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
3019
3020For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
3021in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
3022letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
3023@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
3024a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
3025alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
3026does not include r0 on the output.
3027@end defmac
3028
3029@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
3030Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
3031in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
3032variants.
3033@end defmac
3034
3035@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3036A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3037letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
3038be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
3039
3040It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3041at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
3042comprises a subset of all memory references including
3043all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
3044pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3045type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
3046
3047For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
3048memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
3049register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
3050@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
3051If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
3052a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
3053reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
3054into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
3055an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
3056@end defmac
3057
3058@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3059A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3060letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3061@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3062be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3063
3064It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3065at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3066a subset of all memory addresses including
3067all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3068pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3069type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3070
3071Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3072be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3073analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3074@end defmac
3075
3076@node Stack and Calling
3077@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3078@cindex calling conventions
3079
3080@c prevent bad page break with this line
3081This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3082
3083@menu
3084* Frame Layout::
3085* Exception Handling::
3086* Stack Checking::
3087* Frame Registers::
3088* Elimination::
3089* Stack Arguments::
3090* Register Arguments::
3091* Scalar Return::
3092* Aggregate Return::
3093* Caller Saves::
3094* Function Entry::
3095* Profiling::
3096* Tail Calls::
3097* Stack Smashing Protection::
3098@end menu
3099
3100@node Frame Layout
3101@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3102@cindex stack frame layout
3103@cindex frame layout
3104
3105@c prevent bad page break with this line
3106Here is the basic stack layout.
3107
3108@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3109Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3110pointer to a smaller address.
3111
3112When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3113compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3114definition used does not matter.
3115@end defmac
3116
3117@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3118This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3119on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3120@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3121
3122The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3123and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3124the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3125to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3126space for the next item on the stack.
3127
3128The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3129defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3130which is often wrong.
3131@end defmac
3132
3133@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3134Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3135are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3136@end defmac
3137
3138@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3139Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3140addresses on the stack.
3141@end defmac
3142
3143@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3144Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3145
3146If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3147subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3148Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3149value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3150@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3151@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3152@end defmac
3153
3154@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3155Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3156The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3157
3158On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3159is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3160alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3161stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3162@end defmac
3163
3164@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3165Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3166outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3167zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3168
3169If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3170the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3171@end defmac
3172
3173@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3174Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3175address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3176function.
3177
3178If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3179the first argument's address.
3180@end defmac
3181
3182@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3183Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3184on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3185
3186The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3187length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3188machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3189@end defmac
3190
3191@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3192A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3193stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3194@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3195default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3196elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3197@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3198@end defmac
3199
3200@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3201A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3202frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3203@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3204itself.
3205
3206If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3207of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3208address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3209@end defmac
3210
3211@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3212If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3213setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3214on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3215before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3216define this macro.
3217@end defmac
3218
3219@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3220This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3221the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3222The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3223machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3224@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3225@end deftypefn
3226
3227@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3228A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3229address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3230of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3231You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3232as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3233@end defmac
3234
3235@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3236A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3237address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3238the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3239frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3240@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3241
3242The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3243@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3244determine the return address of other frames.
3245@end defmac
3246
3247@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3248Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3249from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3250@end defmac
3251
3252@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3253A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3254incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3255prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3256value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3257the stack.
3258
3259You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3260debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3261
3262If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3263@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3264@end defmac
3265
3266@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3267A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3268number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3269must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3270be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3271
3272This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3273general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3274frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3275over time.
3276@end defmac
3277
3278@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3279A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3280number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3281only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3282someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3283terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3284@end defmac
3285
3286@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3287This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3288contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3289info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3290@smallexample
3291(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3292@end smallexample
3293and
3294@smallexample
3295(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3296@end smallexample
3297to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3298the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3299the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3300@end deftypefn
3301
3302@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3303A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3304from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3305frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3306the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3307previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3308
3309You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3310debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3311@end defmac
3312
3313@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3314A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3315from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3316final value should coincide with that calculated by
3317@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3318during virtual register instantiation.
3319
3320The default value for this macro is
3321@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3322which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3323immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3324some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3325and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3326
3327You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3328want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3329DWARF 2.
3330@end defmac
3331
3332@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3333If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3334in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3335The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3336@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3337
3338Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3339via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3340variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3341defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3342based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3343of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3344should be defined.
3345@end defmac
3346
3347@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3348If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3349in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3350in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3351may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3352@end defmac
3353
3354@node Exception Handling
3355@subsection Exception Handling Support
3356@cindex exception handling
3357
3358@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3359A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3360data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3361@var{N} registers are usable.
3362
3363The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3364handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3365should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3366but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33672 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3368
3369You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3370handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3371@end defmac
3372
3373@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3374A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3375to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3376This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3377It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3378
3379Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3380untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3381
3382Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3383by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3384this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3385stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3386this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3387that provided by DWARF 2.
3388@end defmac
3389
3390@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3391A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3392to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3393return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3394
3395Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3396return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3397address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3398the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3399frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3400been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3401target call frame.
3402
3403Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3404address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3405the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3406
3407If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3408define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3409@end defmac
3410
3411@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3412If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3413to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3414exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3415using it to return to the exception handler.
3416@end defmac
3417
3418@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3419This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3420handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3421that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3422and so may be read-only.
3423
3424@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3425@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3426The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3427as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3428
3429If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3430represented directly.
3431@end defmac
3432
3433@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3434This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3435to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3436Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3437be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3438
3439This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3440handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3441of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3442to be emitted.
3443@end defmac
3444
3445@defmac MD_UNWIND_SUPPORT
3446A string specifying a file to be #include'd in unwind-dw2.c. The file
3447so included typically defines @code{MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR}.
3448@end defmac
3449
3450@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3451This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3452code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3453available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3454through signal frames.
3455
3456This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3457@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3458@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3459@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3460for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3461the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3462save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3463evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3464the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3465
3466For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3467@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3468@end defmac
3469
3470@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3471This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3472call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3473usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3474
3475This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in @file{unwind-ia64.c}.
3476@var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3477@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3478for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3479@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3480be updated in @var{fs}.
3481@end defmac
3482
3483@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3484A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3485info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3486linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3487@end defmac
3488
3489@node Stack Checking
3490@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3491
3492GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3493stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3494three ways:
3495
3496@enumerate
3497@item
3498If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3499will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3500at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3501other special processing.
3502
3503@item
3504If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3505@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3506that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3507static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3508in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3509stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3510approach below.
3511
3512@item
3513If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3514``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3515@end enumerate
3516
3517If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3518GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3519@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3520dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3521
3522@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3523A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3524machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3525is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3526checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3527value of this macro is zero.
3528@end defmac
3529
3530@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3531A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3532in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3533like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3534approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3535@end defmac
3536
3537@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3538An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3539instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3540define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3541the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3542of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3543@end defmac
3544
3545@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3546An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3547when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3548contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3549thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3550is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3551default value of this macro is zero.
3552@end defmac
3553
3554@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3555The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3556languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3557with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
35588192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3559most machines.
3560@end defmac
3561
3562The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3563nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3564in the opposite case.
3565
3566@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3567The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3568instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3569stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3570checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3571default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3572systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3573@end defmac
3574
3575@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3576GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3577represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3578space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3579You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3580use the default of four words.
3581@end defmac
3582
3583@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3584The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3585fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3586@option{-fstack-check}.
3587GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3588normally not need to override that default.
3589@end defmac
3590
3591@need 2000
3592@node Frame Registers
3593@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3594
3595@c prevent bad page break with this line
3596This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3597
3598@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3599The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3600fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3601the hardware determines which register this is.
3602@end defmac
3603
3604@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3605The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3606access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3607hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3608choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3609@end defmac
3610
3611@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3612On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3613offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3614allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3615between these two locations). On those machines, define
3616@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3617be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3618@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3619used for the frame pointer.
3620
3621You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3622is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3623the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3624completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3625definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3626@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3627or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3628
3629Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3630@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3631@end defmac
3632
3633@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3634The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3635the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3636frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3637register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3638wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3639pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3640@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3641(@pxref{Elimination}).
3642@end defmac
3643
e3339d0f
JM
3644@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3645Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3646@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3647the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3648== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3649definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3650@end defmac
3651
3652@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3653Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3654@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3655same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3656ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3657definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3658@end defmac
3659
38f8b050
JR
3660@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3661The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3662access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3663machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3664pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3665to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3666@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3667
3668Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3669address from the stack.
3670@end defmac
3671
3672@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3673@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3674Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3675register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3676function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3677number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3678these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3679not be defined.
3680
3681The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3682
3683If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3684defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3685@end defmac
3686
3687@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3688This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3689targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3690nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3691attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3692those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3693
3694The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3695
3696If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3697provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3698Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3699from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3700will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3701@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3702@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3703@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3704The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3705@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3706to refer to those items.
3707@end deftypefn
3708
3709@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3710This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3711saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3712DWARF2 exception handling.
3713
3714Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3715exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3716extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3717in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3718used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3719routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3720registers that are not call-saved.
3721
3722If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3723@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3724@end defmac
3725
3726@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3727
3728This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3729for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3730
3731If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3732@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3733@end defmac
3734
3735@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3736
3737Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3738is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3739Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3740column number to use instead.
3741
3742See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3743@end defmac
3744
3745@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3746
3747Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3748used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3749debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3750should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3751@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3752
3753@end defmac
3754
3755@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3756
3757Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3758that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3759should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3760.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3761return @code{@var{regno}}.
3762
3763@end defmac
3764
3765@node Elimination
3766@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3767
3768@c prevent bad page break with this line
3769This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3770
3771@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3772This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3773a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3774value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3775
3776This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3777according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3778constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3779to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3780Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3781pointer.
3782
3783In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3784without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3785automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3786@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3787them.
3788
3789In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3790register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3791fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3792
3793Default return value is @code{false}.
3794@end deftypefn
3795
3796@findex get_frame_size
3797@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3798A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3799between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3800the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3801such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3802registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3803
3804If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3805need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3806@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3807case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3808@end defmac
3809
3810@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3811If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3812eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3813defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3814references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3815
3816The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3817of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3818
3819On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3820the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3821must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3822replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3823depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3824
3825In this case, you might specify:
3826@smallexample
3827#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3828@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3829 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3830 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3831@end smallexample
3832
3833Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3834specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3835@end defmac
3836
3837@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3838This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3839try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3840@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3841is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3842preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3843knows about.
3844
3845Default return value is @code{true}.
3846@end deftypefn
3847
3848@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3849This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3850specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3851registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3852defined.
3853@end defmac
3854
3855@node Stack Arguments
3856@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3857@cindex arguments on stack
3858@cindex stack arguments
3859
3860The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3861on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3862control passing certain arguments in registers.
3863
3864@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3865This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3866prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3867passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3868cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3869The default is to not promote prototypes.
3870@end deftypefn
3871
3872@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3873A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3874outgoing arguments.
3875If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3876That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3877allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3878it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3879@end defmac
3880
3881@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3882A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3883last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3884defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3885and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3886@end defmac
3887
3888@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3889A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3890stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3891
3892On some machines, the definition
3893
3894@smallexample
3895#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3896@end smallexample
3897
3898@noindent
3899will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3900to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3901alignment. Then the definition should be
3902
3903@smallexample
3904#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3905@end smallexample
3906@end defmac
3907
3908@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3909@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3910A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3911will be computed and placed into the variable
3912@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3913onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3914increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3915
3916Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3917is not proper.
3918@end defmac
3919
3920@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3921Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3922allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3923registers.
3924
3925The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3926arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3927which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3928The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3929of the function.
3930
3931This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3932machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3933which.
3934@end defmac
3935@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3936@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3937
3938@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3939Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3940caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3941when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3942if the function called is a library function.
3943
3944If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3945whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3946@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3947@end defmac
3948
3949@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3950Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3951stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3952@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3953@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3954
3955Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3956stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3957suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3958stack in its natural location.
3959@end defmac
3960
893d13d5 3961@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3962This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3963a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3964and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3965
3966@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3967the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3968@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3969From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3970
3971@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3972describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3973@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3974From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3975arguments (if known).
3976
3977When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3978will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3979you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3980by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3981a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3982in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3983
893d13d5 3984@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3985stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3986argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3987
3988On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3989of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3990calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3991the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3992convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3993arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3994nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3995@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3996number of arguments.
3997@end deftypefn
3998
3999@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
4000A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
4001pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
4002when compiling a function call.
4003
4004@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
4005have been accumulated.
4006
4007On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
4008that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
4009that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
4010call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
4011appropriate.
4012@end defmac
4013
4014@node Register Arguments
4015@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
4016@cindex arguments in registers
4017@cindex registers arguments
4018
4019This section describes the macros which let you control how various
4020types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
4021the stack.
4022
4023@defmac FUNCTION_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4024A C expression that controls whether a function argument is passed
4025in a register, and which register.
4026
4027The arguments are @var{cum}, which summarizes all the previous
4028arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
4029the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
4030(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
4031which is 1 for an ordinary argument and 0 for nameless arguments that
4032correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called function's prototype.
4033@var{type} can be an incomplete type if a syntax error has previously
4034occurred.
4035
4036The value of the expression is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the
4037hard register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the
4038argument on the stack.
4039
4040For machines like the VAX and 68000, where normally all arguments are
4041pushed, zero suffices as a definition.
4042
4043The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
4044used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
4045@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
4046@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4047describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4048@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4049register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4050register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4051second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4052the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4053As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4054RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4055argument is also stored on the stack.
4056
4057The last time this macro is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4058VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4059pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4060
4061@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4062The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a machine
4063where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to cause
4064nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is done
4065by making @code{FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever @var{named} is 0.
4066
4067@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4068@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4069You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4070in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4071type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4072is not defined and @code{FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4073argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4074defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4075a register.
4076@end defmac
4077
4078@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4079This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4080solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4081definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4082documentation.
4083@end deftypefn
4084
4085@defmac FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4086Define this macro if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
4087that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4088necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4089argument.
4090
4091For such machines, @code{FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in which
4092the caller passes the value, and @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should
4093be defined in a similar fashion to tell the function being called
4094where the arguments will arrive.
4095
4096If @code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined, @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
4097serves both purposes.
4098@end defmac
4099
4100@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4101This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4102argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4103arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4104pushed on the stack.
4105
4106On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4107registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4108first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4109on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4110structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4111in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4112compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4113
4114@code{FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4115register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4116@code{FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4117@end deftypefn
4118
ec9f85e5 4119@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4120This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4121position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4122predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4123passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4124
4125If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4126pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4127The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4128to that type.
4129@end deftypefn
4130
4131@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4132The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4133known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4134function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4135by the caller.
4136
4137For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4138determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4139not be generated.
4140
4141The default version of this hook always returns false.
4142@end deftypefn
4143
4144@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4145A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument of
4146@code{FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some target machines,
4147the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number of bytes of
4148argument so far.
4149
4150There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4151arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4152variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4153arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4154@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4155should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4156@end defmac
4157
4158@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4159If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4160function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4161created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4162reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4163If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4164@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4165@end defmac
4166
4167@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4168A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4169@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4170variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4171is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4172the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4173For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4174declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4175@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4176being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4177arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4178parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4179@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4180
4181When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4182@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4183contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4184an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4185macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4186never both of them at once.
4187@end defmac
4188
4189@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4190Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4191it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4192@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4193is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41940)} is used instead.
4195@end defmac
4196
4197@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4198Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4199finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4200undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4201
4202The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4203with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4204argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4205@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4206@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4207@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4208@end defmac
4209
4210@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{named})
4211A C statement (sans semicolon) to update the summarizer variable
4212@var{cum} to advance past an argument in the argument list. The
4213values @var{mode}, @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument.
4214Once this is done, the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing
4215the @emph{following} argument with @code{FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4216
4217This macro need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4218on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4219used for arguments without any special help.
4220@end defmac
4221
4222@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4223If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4224offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4225which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4226slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4227top.
4228@end defmac
4229
4230@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4231If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4232to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4233@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4234@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4235
4236The @emph{amount} of padding is always just enough to reach the next
4237multiple of @code{FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY}; this macro does not control
4238it.
4239
4240This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4241For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4242big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4243constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4244@end defmac
4245
4246@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4247If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4248implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4249next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4250controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4251arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4252@end defmac
4253
4254@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4255Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4256memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4257macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4258machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4259@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4260registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4261a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4262required.
4263@end defmac
4264
4265@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4266If defined, a C expression that gives the alignment boundary, in bits,
4267of an argument with the specified mode and type. If it is not defined,
4268@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} is used for all arguments.
4269@end defmac
4270
4271@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4272A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4273register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4274@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4275the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4276used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4277stack.
4278@end defmac
4279
4280@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4281This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4282as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4283arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4284to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4285AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4286registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4287point register.
4288
4289The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4290false.
4291@end deftypefn
4292
4293@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4294This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4295The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4296@end deftypefn
4297
07a5b2bc 4298@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4299This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4300to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4301variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4302to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4303variable.
07a5b2bc 4304The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4305this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4306internal type.
4307If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4308Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4309macro to iterate through all types.
4310@end deftypefn
4311
4312@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4313This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4314@var{fndecl}.
4315The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4316@end deftypefn
4317
4318@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4319This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4320type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4321@code{NULL_TREE}.
4322@end deftypefn
4323
4324@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4325This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4326@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4327arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4328@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4329@end deftypefn
4330
4331@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4332Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4333with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4334hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4335@end deftypefn
4336
4337@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4338Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4339insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4340considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4341must work.
4342
4343The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4344required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4345Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4346code in @file{optabs.c}.
4347@end deftypefn
4348
4349@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4350Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4351insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4352must have move patterns for this mode.
4353@end deftypefn
4354
4355@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4356Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4357small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4358@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4359in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4360In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4361for any mode.
4362
4363On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4364insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4365to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4366if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4367insn.
4368
4369Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4370in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4371the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4372classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4373registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4374registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4375SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4376strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4377machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4378
4379The default version of this hook retuns false for any mode. It is always
4380safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4381unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4382that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4383to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4384of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4385@end deftypefn
4386
4387@node Scalar Return
4388@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4389@cindex return values in registers
4390@cindex values, returned by functions
4391@cindex scalars, returned as values
4392
4393This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4394values---values that can fit in registers.
4395
4396@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4397
4398Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4399returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4400representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4401representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4402function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4403compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4404Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4405a function returns a value.
4406
4407On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4408(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4409place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4410@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4411The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4412multiple places. See @code{FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4413@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4414location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4415the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4416that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4417port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4418@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4419
4420If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4421the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4422@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4423
4424If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4425node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4426pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4427convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4428known.
4429
4430Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4431which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4432the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4433different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4434
4435@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4436aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4437@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4438@end deftypefn
4439
4440@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4441This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4442a new target instead.
4443@end defmac
4444
4445@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4446A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4447function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4448
4449Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4450support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4451specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4452compiled.
4453@end defmac
4454
4455@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4456Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4457function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4458
4459The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4460library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4461representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4462
4463If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4464@end deftypefn
4465
4466@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4467A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4468register in which the values of called function may come back.
4469
4470A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4471second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4472recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4473suffices:
4474
4475@smallexample
4476#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4477@end smallexample
4478
4479If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4480function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4481should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4482
4483This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4484for a new target instead.
4485@end defmac
4486
4487@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4488A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4489register in which the values of called function may come back.
4490
4491A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4492second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4493recognized by this target hook.
4494
4495If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4496function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4497should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4498
4499If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4500@end deftypefn
4501
4502@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4503Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4504need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4505saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4506@end defmac
4507
4508@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4509This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4510at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4511padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4512is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4513
4514Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4515be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4516or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
45174-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4518@code{SImode} rtx.
4519@end deftypefn
4520
4521@node Aggregate Return
4522@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4523@cindex aggregates as return values
4524@cindex large return values
4525@cindex returning aggregate values
4526@cindex structure value address
4527
4528When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4529cases), the value is not returned according to
4530@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4531caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4532should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4533address}.
4534
4535This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4536memory.
4537
4538@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4539This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4540function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4541Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4542will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4543libcalls.
4544
4545Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4546by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4547takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4548possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4549definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4550values, and 0 otherwise.
4551
4552Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4553be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4554to indicate this.
4555@end deftypefn
4556
4557@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4558Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4559in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4560only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4561If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4562and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4563target hook.
4564
4565If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4566@end defmac
4567
4568@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4569This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4570address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4571passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4572be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4573hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4574argument.
4575
4576On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4577is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4578caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4579be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4580@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4581the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4582the caller.
4583
4584If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4585stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4586@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4587structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4588to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4589@end deftypefn
4590
4591@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4592Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4593for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4594the address of a static variable containing the value.
4595
4596Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4597pass an address to the subroutine.
4598
4599This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4600nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4601@end defmac
4602
ffa88471
SE
4603@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4604
4605@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4606
38f8b050
JR
4607@node Caller Saves
4608@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4609
4610If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4611makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4612must live across calls.
4613
4614@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4615A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4616a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4617restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4618this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4619
4620If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4621machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4622@end defmac
4623
4624@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4625A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4626of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4627@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4628returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4629will select the smallest suitable mode.
4630@end defmac
4631
4632@node Function Entry
4633@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4634@cindex function entry and exit
4635@cindex prologue
4636@cindex epilogue
4637
4638This section describes the macros that output function entry
4639(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4640
4641@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4642If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4643function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4644initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4645saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4646local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4647stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4648
4649The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4650macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4651
4652@findex regs_ever_live
4653To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4654@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4655@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4656prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4657call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4658@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4659
4660On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4661not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4662they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4663appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4664registers are used in the function.
4665
4666@findex frame_pointer_needed
4667On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4668function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4669pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4670frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4671@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4672time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4673
4674The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4675required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4676listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4677order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4678stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4679the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4680for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4681compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4682or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4683need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4684@end deftypefn
4685
4686@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4687If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4688prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4689emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4690emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4691@end deftypefn
4692
4693@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4694If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4695epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4696emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4697emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4698@end deftypefn
4699
4700@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4701If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4702function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4703registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4704called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4705same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4706registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4707@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4708
4709On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4710of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4711instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4712@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4713
4714Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4715@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4716switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4717define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4718target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4719condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4720
4721On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4722function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4723two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4724is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4725@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4726a function that needs a frame pointer.
4727
4728Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4729@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4730The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4731function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4732
4733On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4734others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4735given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4736number of arguments.
4737
4738@findex current_function_pops_args
4739Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4740functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4741needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4742function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4743@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4744@end deftypefn
4745
4746@itemize @bullet
4747@item
4748@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4749A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4750uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4751stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4752if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4753arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4754yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4755region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4756registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4757features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4758
4759@item
4760An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4761The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4762the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4763machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4764in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4765a save area.
4766
4767@item
4768A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4769boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4770this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4771save area closer to the top of the stack.
4772
4773@item
4774@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4775Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4776@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4777argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4778@end itemize
4779
4780@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4781Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4782instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4783pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4784adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4785default is 0.
4786
4787Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4788frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4789stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4790compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4791@end defmac
4792
4793@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4794Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4795used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4796pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4797@end defmac
4798
4799@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4800Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4801used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4802on entry to an exception edge.
4803@end defmac
4804
4805@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4806Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4807instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4808definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4809representing the number of delay slots there.
4810@end defmac
4811
4812@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4813A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4814slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4815
4816The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4817being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4818eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4819of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4820If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4821may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4822(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4823slot.
4824
4825@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4826@findex final_scan_insn
4827The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4828list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4829@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4830delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4831@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4832outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4833@code{final_scan_insn}.
4834
4835You need not define this macro if you did not define
4836@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4837@end defmac
4838
4839@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4840A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4841function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4842inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4843adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4844the real function.
4845
4846First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4847contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4848contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4849in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4850e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4851all other incoming arguments.
4852
4853Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4854made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4855adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4856
4857@smallexample
4858p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4859@end smallexample
4860
4861After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4862@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4863not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4864return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4865
4866The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4867the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4868of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4869and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4870
4871The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4872have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4873some targets, but probably not.
4874
4875If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4876front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4877@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4878not support varargs.
4879@end deftypefn
4880
4881@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4882A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4883to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4884arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4885generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4886previously exposed.
4887@end deftypefn
4888
4889@node Profiling
4890@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4891@cindex profiling, code generation
4892
4893These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4894
4895@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4896A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4897assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4898
4899@findex mcount
4900The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4901your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4902compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4903compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4904
4905Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4906variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4907@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4908the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4909@end defmac
4910
4911@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4912A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4913code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4914not support profiling.
4915@end defmac
4916
4917@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4918Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4919@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4920allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4921implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4922@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4923@end defmac
4924
4925@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4926Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4927the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4928@end defmac
4929
4930@node Tail Calls
4931@subsection Permitting tail calls
4932@cindex tail calls
4933
4934@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4935True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4936call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4937or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4938
4939It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4940tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4941during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4942as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4943``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4944may vary greatly between different architectures.
4945@end deftypefn
4946
4947@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4948Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4949function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4950cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4951registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4952TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4953FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4954@end deftypefn
4955
4956@node Stack Smashing Protection
4957@subsection Stack smashing protection
4958@cindex stack smashing protection
4959
4960@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4961This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4962for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4963runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4964that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4965variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4966
4967The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4968@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4969@end deftypefn
4970
4971@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
4972This hook returns a tree expression that alerts the runtime that the
4973stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4974involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4975
4976The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4977@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4978normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4979@end deftypefn
4980
7458026b
ILT
4981@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4982
38f8b050
JR
4983@node Varargs
4984@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4985@cindex varargs implementation
4986
4987GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4988@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4989on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4990varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4991conditionals to include it.
4992
4993ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4994the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4995implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4996to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4997@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4998supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4999
5000However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5001the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5002below.
5003
5004@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5005Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5006that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5007versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5008you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5009
5010On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5011control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5012other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5013found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5014
5015Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5016beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5017@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5018This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5019to use them for its own purposes.
5020@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5021@c 10feb93
5022@end defmac
5023
38f8b050 5024@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 5025This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
5026argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5027returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5028argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5029fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5030verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5031of the current function.
5032@end defmac
5033
5034@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5035Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5036passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5037has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5038specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5039with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5040
5041@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5042considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5043kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5044
5045The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5046interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5047@end defmac
5048
5049These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5050
5051@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5052If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5053@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5054beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5055return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5056to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5057@end deftypefn
5058
5059@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5060This target hook offers an alternative to using
5061@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5062@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5063register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5064have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5065use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5066pass all their arguments on the stack.
5067
5068The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5069structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5070named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5071last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5072
5073The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5074argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5075store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5076variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5077store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5078frame.
5079
5080Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5081compile time without knowing their data types,
5082@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5083have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5084for all data types.
5085
5086If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5087arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5088happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5089end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5090not generate any instructions in this case.
5091@end deftypefn
5092
5093@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5094Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5095argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5096
5097This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{FUNCTION_ARG}
5098is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5099@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5100arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5101but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5102then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5103except the last are treated as named.
5104
5105You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5106@end deftypefn
5107
5108@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5109If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5110@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5111@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5112defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5113@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5114Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5115@end deftypefn
5116
5117@node Trampolines
5118@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5119@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5120@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5121
5122A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5123when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5124the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5125tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5126trampoline.
5127
5128The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5129address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5130the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5131two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5132exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5133machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5134two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5135operands.
5136
5137The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5138parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5139immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5140simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5141proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5142may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5143separately.
5144
5145@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5146This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5147on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5148the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5149label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5150
5151If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5152for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5153code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5154to generate it on the spot.
5155@end deftypefn
5156
5157@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5158Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5159(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5160@end defmac
5161
5162@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5163A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5164@end defmac
5165
5166@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5167Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5168
5169If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5170is used for aligning trampolines.
5171@end defmac
5172
5173@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5174This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5175@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5176is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5177RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5178when it is called.
5179
5180If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5181first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5182from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5183Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5184trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5185to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5186
5187If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5188enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5189initializing the trampoline proper.
5190@end deftypefn
5191
5192@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5193This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5194the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5195memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5196the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5197address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5198be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5199If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5200@end deftypefn
5201
5202Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5203separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5204fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5205jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5206
5207Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5208the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5209make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5210subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5211latter makes initialization faster.
5212
5213To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5214the following macro.
5215
5216@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5217If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5218cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5219typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5220@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5221@end defmac
5222
5223The operating system may also require the stack to be made executable
5224before calling the trampoline. To implement this requirement, define
5225the following macro.
5226
5227@defmac ENABLE_EXECUTE_STACK
5228Define this macro if certain operations must be performed before executing
5229code located on the stack. The macro should expand to a series of C
5230file-scope constructs (e.g.@: functions) and provide a unique entry point
5231named @code{__enable_execute_stack}. The target is responsible for
5232emitting calls to the entry point in the code, for example from the
5233@code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT} hook.
5234@end defmac
5235
5236To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5237you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5238cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5239beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5240its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5241
5242@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5243Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5244work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5245which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5246@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5247
5248If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5249C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5250special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5251statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5252global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5253special assembler code.
5254@end defmac
5255
5256@node Library Calls
5257@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5258@cindex library subroutine names
5259@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5260
5261@c prevent bad page break with this line
5262Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5263
5264@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5265This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5266expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5267provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5268are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5269@end defmac
5270
5271@findex set_optab_libfunc
5272@findex init_one_libfunc
5273@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5274This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5275existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5276@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5277@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5278library routines.
5279
5280The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5281@end deftypefn
5282
5283@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5284This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5285implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5286mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5287return a tristate.
5288
5289GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5290comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5291don't need to define this macro.
5292@end defmac
5293
5294@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5295This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5296functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5297operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5298and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5299If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5300@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5301in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5302@end defmac
5303
5304@cindex US Software GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5305@cindex floating point emulation library, US Software GOFAST
5306@cindex GOFAST, floating point emulation library
5307@findex gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs
5308@defmac US_SOFTWARE_GOFAST
5309Define this macro if your system C library uses the US Software GOFAST
5310library to provide floating point emulation.
5311
5312In addition to defining this macro, your architecture must set
5313@code{TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS} to @code{gofast_maybe_init_libfuncs}, or
5314else call that function from its version of that hook. It is defined
5315in @file{config/gofast.h}, which must be included by your
5316architecture's @file{@var{cpu}.c} file. See @file{sparc/sparc.c} for
5317an example.
5318
5319If this macro is defined, the
5320@code{TARGET_FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL} target hook must return
5321false for @code{SFmode} and @code{DFmode} comparisons.
5322@end defmac
5323
5324@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5325@findex matherr
5326@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5327The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5328expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5329deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5330@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5331system.
5332
5333If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5334domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5335error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5336there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5337that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5338@end defmac
5339
5340@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5341@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5342Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5343refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5344@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5345macro, a reasonable default is used.
5346@end defmac
5347
5348@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5349@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5350When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5351@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5352default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5353functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5354systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5355@end defmac
5356
5357@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5358@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5359When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5360and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5361default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5362@smallexample
5363void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5364void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5365void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5366@end smallexample
5367@end defmac
5368
5369@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5370Define this macro to generate code for Objective-C message sending using
5371the calling convention of the NeXT system. This calling convention
5372involves passing the object, the selector and the method arguments all
5373at once to the method-lookup library function.
5374
5375The default calling convention passes just the object and the selector
5376to the lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5377@end defmac
5378
5379@node Addressing Modes
5380@section Addressing Modes
5381@cindex addressing modes
5382
5383@c prevent bad page break with this line
5384This is about addressing modes.
5385
5386@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5387@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5388@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5389@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5390A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5391pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5392@end defmac
5393
5394@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5395@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5396A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5397post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5398the size of the memory operand.
5399@end defmac
5400
5401@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5402@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5403A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5404post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5405@end defmac
5406
5407@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5408A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5409is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5410@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5411is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5412constant addresses are supported.
5413@end defmac
5414
5415@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5416@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5417accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5418known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5419expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5420@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5421@end defmac
5422
5423@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5424A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5425memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5426the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5427accept.
5428@end defmac
5429
5430@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5431A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5432address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5433
5434Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5435non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5436desired by the caller.
5437
5438The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5439that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5440considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5441kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5442must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5443up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5444register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5445if the array holds @code{-1}.
5446
5447The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5448accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5449register is required.
5450
5451Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5452and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5453constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5454specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5455recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5456
5457Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5458sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5459@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5460naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5461be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5462
5463@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5464On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5465the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5466target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5467into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5468@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5469@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5470Format}.
5471
5472@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5473Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5474this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5475has this syntax:
5476
5477@example
5478#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5479@end example
5480
5481@noindent
5482and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5483address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5484Whether the strict or non-strict variants are desired is defined by
5485the @code{REG_OK_STRICT} macro introduced earlier in this section.
5486Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5487files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5488@end deftypefn
5489
5490@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5491A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5492character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5493letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5494@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5495support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5496semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5497preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5498@code{'m'} constraint.
5499@end defmac
5500
5501@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5502A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5503or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5504can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5505@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5506
5507It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5508that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5509
5510The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5511a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5512@end defmac
5513
5514@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5515This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5516operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5517address.
5518
5519@findex break_out_memory_refs
5520@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5521and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5522@var{x}.
5523
5524The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5525@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5526should return the new @var{x}.
5527
5528It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address.
5529The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, it
5530is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5531a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5532strategy can generate better code.
5533@end deftypefn
5534
5535@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5536A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5537that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5538@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5539It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5540performance reasons.
5541
5542For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5543reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5544registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5545processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5546needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5547@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5548generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5549be shared.
5550
5551@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5552to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5553and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5554of reload internals.
5555
5556@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5557previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5558then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5559
5560@findex push_reload
5561The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5562need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5563suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5564
5565The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5566@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5567should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5568This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5569@code{push_reload}.
5570
5571@findex strict_memory_address_p
5572The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5573the address has become legitimate.
5574
5575@findex copy_rtx
5576If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5577this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5578single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5579top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5580It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5581address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5582@end defmac
5583
5584@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5585This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5586different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5587reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5588but not others.
5589
5590Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5591effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5592of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5593addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5594
5595You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5596
5597The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5598@end deftypefn
5599
5600@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5601A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5602@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5603different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5604reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5605but not others.
5606
5607Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5608effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5609of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5610addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5611
5612You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5613
5614These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5615@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5616@end defmac
5617
5618@defmac LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5619A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for
5620an immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5621@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this. In fact,
5622@samp{1} is a suitable definition for this macro on machines where
5623anything @code{CONSTANT_P} is valid.
5624@end defmac
5625
5626@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5627This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5628@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5629macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5630references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5631addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5632the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5633into their original form.
5634@end deftypefn
5635
5636@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5637This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5638should not) be spilled to the constant pool. The default version of
5639this hook returns false.
5640
5641The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5642deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5643from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5644holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5645of TLS symbols for various targets.
5646@end deftypefn
5647
5648@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5649This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5650be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5651of @var{x}.
5652
5653The default version returns false for all constants.
5654@end deftypefn
5655
89356d17 5656@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5657This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5658the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5659@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5660when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5661@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5662of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5663function are valid.
5664@end deftypefn
5665
5666@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5667This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5668address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5669used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5670@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5671
5672The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5673@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5674the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5675@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5676two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5677@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5678the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5679from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5680@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5681@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5682@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5683
5684If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5685to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5686use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5687@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5688should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5689described above.
5690If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5691the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5692log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5693@end deftypefn
5694
5695@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN
5696This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5697widening multiplication of the even elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5698
5699If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5700@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD} target hook when vectorizing
5701widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5702preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5703@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5704@end deftypefn
5705
5706@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_ODD
5707This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that implements
5708widening multiplication of the odd elements of two input vectors of type @var{x}.
5709
5710If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use it along with the
5711@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MUL_WIDEN_EVEN} target hook when vectorizing
5712widening multiplication in cases that the order of the results does not have to be
5713preserved (e.g.@: used only by a reduction computation). Otherwise, the
5714@code{widen_mult_hi/lo} idioms will be used.
5715@end deftypefn
5716
5717@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5718Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
720f5239
IR
5719For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5720misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5721@end deftypefn
5722
5723@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5724Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5725@end deftypefn
5726
5727@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM
5728Target builtin that implements vector permute.
5729@end deftypefn
5730
5731@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VEC_PERM_OK
5732Return true if a vector created for @code{builtin_vec_perm} is valid.
5733@end deftypefn
5734
5735@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5736This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5737input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5738The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5739specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5740(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5741
5742If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5743@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5744conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5745@end deftypefn
5746
5747@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5748This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5749vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5750@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5751The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5752return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5753@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5754@end deftypefn
5755
5756@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5757This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5758store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5759parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5760the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5761parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5762@end deftypefn
5763
cc4b5170
RG
5764@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5765This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5766mode @var{mode}. The default is
5767equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5768transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5769@end deftypefn
5770
767f865f
RG
5771@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5772This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5773after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5774mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5775The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5776@end deftypefn
5777
38f8b050
JR
5778@node Anchored Addresses
5779@section Anchored Addresses
5780@cindex anchored addresses
5781@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5782
5783GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5784For example, if we have:
5785
5786@smallexample
5787static int a, b, c;
5788int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5789@end smallexample
5790
5791the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5792addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5793it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5794the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5795be something like:
5796
5797@smallexample
5798int foo (void)
5799@{
5800 register int *xr = &x;
5801 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5802@}
5803@end smallexample
5804
5805(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5806``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5807
5808The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5809in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5810section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5811or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5812
5813@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5814The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5815On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5816applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5817for every mode. The default value is 0.
5818@end deftypevr
5819
5820@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5821Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5822offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5823value is 0.
5824@end deftypevr
5825
5826@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5827Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5828@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5829The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5830of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5831
5832If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5833it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5834If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5835is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5836@end deftypefn
5837
5838@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5839Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5840@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5841@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5842
5843The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5844intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5845or target-specific sections.
5846@end deftypefn
5847
5848@node Condition Code
5849@section Condition Code Status
5850@cindex condition code status
5851
5852The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5853two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5854
5855The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5856(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5857clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5858register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5859architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5860most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5861most RISC machines.
5862
5863The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5864the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5865insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5866optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5867is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5868three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5869scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5870separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5871
5872For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5873represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5874condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5875condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5876or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5877Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5878that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5879
5880Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5881specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5882interested in most macros in this section.
5883
5884@menu
5885* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5886* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5887* Cond. Exec. Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
5888@end menu
5889
5890@node CC0 Condition Codes
5891@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5892@findex cc0
5893
5894@findex cc_status
5895The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5896describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5897the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5898variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5899currently based, and several standard flags.
5900
5901Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5902description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5903information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5904
5905@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5906C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5907component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5908
5909This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5910@end defmac
5911
5912@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5913A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5914The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5915the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5916define this macro to initialize it.
5917
5918This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5919@end defmac
5920
5921@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5922A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5923appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5924this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5925code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5926set @code{(cc0)}.
5927
5928This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5929
5930If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5931other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5932invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5933reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5934registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5935@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5936insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5937based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5938value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5939this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5940@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5941@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5942condition code value.
5943
5944The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5945with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5946@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5947constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5948insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5949@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5950@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5951
5952A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5953that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5954@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5955two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5956@end defmac
5957
5958@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5959@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5960@findex CCmode
5961@findex MODE_CC
5962
5963@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5964On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5965than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5966code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5967when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5968bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5969branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5970this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5971record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5972also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5973unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5974
5975If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5976@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5977a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5978have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5979by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5980be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5981the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5982
5983@smallexample
5984(define_insn ""
5985 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5986 (compare:CC_NOOV
5987 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5988 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5989 (const_int 0)))]
5990 ""
5991 "@dots{}")
5992@end smallexample
5993
5994@noindent
5995together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5996for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5997
5998@smallexample
5999#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6000 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6001 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
6002 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6003 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
6004 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6005@end smallexample
6006
6007Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6008were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6009this section.
6010
6011You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6012in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6013@end defmac
6014
6015@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
6016On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6017convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6018does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6019comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6020
6021On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
6022required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
6023and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
6024comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
6025@var{op1} as required.
6026
6027GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6028valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6029@file{md} file.
6030
6031You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
6032code or operands.
6033@end defmac
6034
6035@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6036A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6037comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6038can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6039then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6040
6041You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6042floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6043For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6044inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
6045
6046@smallexample
6047#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
6048@end smallexample
6049@end defmac
6050
6051@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6052A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6053comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6054@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6055machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6056instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6057freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6058like:
6059
6060@smallexample
6061#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6062 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6063 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6064@end smallexample
6065@end defmac
6066
6067@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6068On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6069register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6070regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6071hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6072small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6073to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6074arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6075When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6076integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6077@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6078
6079The default version of this hook returns false.
6080@end deftypefn
6081
6082@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6083On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6084@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6085validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6086target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6087both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6088return @code{VOIDmode}.
6089
6090The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6091same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6092returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6093@end deftypefn
6094
6095@node Cond. Exec. Macros
6096@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6097@findex conditional execution
6098@findex predication
6099
6100There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6101supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6102represent conditional branches.
6103
6104@defmac REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (@var{op1}, @var{op2})
6105A C expression that returns true if the conditional execution predicate
6106@var{op1}, a comparison operation, is the inverse of @var{op2} and vice
6107versa. Define this to return 0 if the target has conditional execution
6108predicates that cannot be reversed safely. There is no need to validate
6109that the arguments of op1 and op2 are the same, this is done separately.
6110If no expansion is specified, this macro is defined as follows:
6111
6112@smallexample
6113#define REVERSE_CONDEXEC_PREDICATES_P (x, y) \
6114 (GET_CODE ((x)) == reversed_comparison_code ((y), NULL))
6115@end smallexample
6116@end defmac
6117
6118@node Costs
6119@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6120@cindex costs of instructions
6121@cindex relative costs
6122@cindex speed of instructions
6123
6124These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6125on the target machine.
6126
6127@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6128A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6129register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6130expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6131value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6132that.
6133
6134It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6135same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6136registers if they are not general registers.
6137
6138If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6139hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6140classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6141constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6142allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6143if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6144
6145These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6146@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6147@end defmac
6148
6149@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6150This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6151from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6152are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6153A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6154that.
6155
6156It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6157same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6158registers if they are not general registers.
6159
6160If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6161hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6162classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6163constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6164allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6165if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6166
6167The default version of this function returns 2.
6168@end deftypefn
6169
6170@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6171A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6172register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6173is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6174is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6175registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6176should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6177
6178If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6179the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6180needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6181between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6182more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6183reflect the actual cost of the move.
6184
6185GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6186secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6187a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6188secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61894 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6190value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6191are the same as to this macro.
6192
6193These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6194@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6195@end defmac
6196
911852ff 6197@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6198This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6199between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6200if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6201This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6202If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6203registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6204
6205If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6206the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6207needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6208between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6209more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6210reflect the actual cost of the move.
6211
6212GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6213secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6214a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6215secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62164 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6217value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6218are the same as to this target hook.
6219@end deftypefn
6220
6221@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6222A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is the
6223default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter @var{speed_p}
6224is true when the branch in question should be optimized for speed. When
6225it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should be returning value optimal for code size
6226rather then performance considerations. @var{predictable_p} is true for well
6227predictable branches. On many architectures the @code{BRANCH_COST} can be
6228reduced then.
6229@end defmac
6230
6231Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6232but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6233ordinarily expect.
6234
6235@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6236Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6237than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6238faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6239require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6240between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6241
6242When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6243finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6244load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6245faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6246may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6247other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6248@end defmac
6249
6250@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6251Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6252@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6253than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6254handler.
6255
6256When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6257@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6258moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6259Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6260cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6261
6262If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6263this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6264@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6265@end defmac
6266
6267@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6268The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6269which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6270string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6271make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6272
6273Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6274@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6275the number of such sequences.
6276
6277The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6278optimized for speed rather than size.
6279
6280If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6281@end defmac
6282
6283@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6284A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6285copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6286will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6287than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6288@end defmac
6289
6290@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6291A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6292a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6293@end defmac
6294
6295@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6296The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6297of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6298or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6299eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6300
6301The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6302optimized for speed rather than size.
6303
6304If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6305@end defmac
6306
6307@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6308A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6309to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6310will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6311than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6312@end defmac
6313
6314@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6315The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6316of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6317a block set insn or a library call.
6318Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6319eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6320
6321The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6322optimized for speed rather than size.
6323
6324If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6325@end defmac
6326
6327@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6328A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6329used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6330other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
6331storing values other than constant zero.
6332Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6333than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6334@end defmac
6335
6336@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6337A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6338used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6339other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6340called with a constant source string.
6341Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6342than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6343@end defmac
6344
6345@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6346A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6347thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6348@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6349@end defmac
6350
6351@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6352A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6353thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6354@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6355@end defmac
6356
6357@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6358A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6359thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6360@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6361@end defmac
6362
6363@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6364A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6365thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6366@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6367@end defmac
6368
6369@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6370A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6371thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6372@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6373@end defmac
6374
6375@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6376A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6377thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6378@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6379@end defmac
6380
6381@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6382This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6383thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6384@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6385@end defmac
6386
6387@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6388This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6389thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6390@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6391@end defmac
6392
6393@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6394Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6395function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6396@end defmac
6397
6398@defmac RANGE_TEST_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6399Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6400@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6401@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6402@end defmac
6403
6404@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6405This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6406
6407The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6408available for examination in @var{x}, and the rtx code of the expression
6409in which it is contained, found in @var{outer_code}. @var{code} is the
6410expression code---redundant, since it can be obtained with
6411@code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
6412
6413In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6414@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6415instructions.
6416
6417On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6418for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6419necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6420for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6421operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6422
6423When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6424false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6425size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6426
6427The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6428processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6429@end deftypefn
6430
6431@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6432This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6433@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6434the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6435
6436For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6437true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6438instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6439all addresses will have equal costs.
6440
6441In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6442the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6443cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6444
6445For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6446and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6447is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6448references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6449the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6450that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6451instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6452specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6453
6454This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6455
6456On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6457cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6458@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6459be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6460@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6461should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6462should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6463registers on machines with lots of registers.
6464@end deftypefn
6465
6466@node Scheduling
6467@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6468
6469The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6470adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6471hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6472them: try the first ones in this list first.
6473
6474@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6475This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6476issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6477Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6478an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6479constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6480hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6481This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6482it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6483@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6484@end deftypefn
6485
6486@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6487This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6488from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6489still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6490@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6491@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6492You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6493than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6494@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6495debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6496@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6497was scheduled.
6498@end deftypefn
6499
6500@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6501This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6502relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6503dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6504is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6505to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6506that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6507data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6508description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6509output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6510times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6511acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6512@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6513@end deftypefn
6514
6515@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6516This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6517@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6518execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6519later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6520scheduling priorities of insns.
6521@end deftypefn
6522
6523@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6524This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6525list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6526combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6527@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6528debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6529@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6530list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6531a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6532reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6533@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6534is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6535the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6536can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6537@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6538@end deftypefn
6539
6540@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6541Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6542function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6543is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6544@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6545return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6546this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6547scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6548cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6549@end deftypefn
6550
6551@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6552This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6553chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6554correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6555example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6556analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6557dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6558calculated.
6559@end deftypefn
6560
6561@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6562This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6563instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6564pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6565is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6566@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6567region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6568scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6569@end deftypefn
6570
6571@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6572This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6573instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6574cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6575is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6576to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6577@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6578@end deftypefn
6579
6580@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6581This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6582@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6583@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6584@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6585@end deftypefn
6586
6587@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6588This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6589@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6590@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6591@end deftypefn
6592
6593@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6594The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6595pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6596when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6597simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6598processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6599based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6600when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6601@end deftypefn
6602
6603@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6604The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6605@end deftypefn
6606
6607@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6608The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6609to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6610simulated processor cycle finishes.
6611@end deftypefn
6612
6613@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6614The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6615used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6619The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6620The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6621to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6622state on a single insn is not enough.
6623@end deftypefn
6624
6625@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6626The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6627The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6628to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6629state on a single insn is not enough.
6630@end deftypefn
6631
6632@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6633This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6634for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6635chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6636value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6637@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6638subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6639maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6640@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6641packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6642rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6643
6644This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6645processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6646with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6647@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6648@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6649processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6650@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6651until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6652the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6653
6654Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6655pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6656schedules to choose the best one.
6657
6658The default is no multipass scheduling.
6659@end deftypefn
6660
6661@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6662
6663This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6664considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6665zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6666be issued.
6667
6668The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6669@end deftypefn
6670
c06bbdf7 6671@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6672This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6673on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6674@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6675the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6676is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6677start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6678verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6679@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6680processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6681and the current processor cycle.
6682@end deftypefn
6683
6684@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6685This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6686the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6687are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6688to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6689being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6690dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6691parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6692The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6693insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6694and @code{false} otherwise.
6695
6696Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6697where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6698delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6699that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6700important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6701closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6702not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6703@end deftypefn
6704
6705@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6706This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6707the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6708per instruction data structures.
6709@end deftypefn
6710
6711@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6712Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6713@end deftypefn
6714
6715@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6716Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6717It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6718beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6719@end deftypefn
6720
6721@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6722Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6723@end deftypefn
6724
6725@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6726Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6727@end deftypefn
6728
6729@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6730Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6731@end deftypefn
6732
6733@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6734This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6735speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6736The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6737version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6738pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6739or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6740speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6741the generated speculative pattern.
6742@end deftypefn
6743
6744@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6745This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6746for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6747instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6748@end deftypefn
6749
6750@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6751This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6752check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6753speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6754@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6755be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6756recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6757a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6758@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6759@end deftypefn
6760
6761@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6762This hook is used as a workaround for
6763@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6764called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6765discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6766being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6767@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6768For non-speculative instructions,
6769the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6770the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6771is nearly full.
6772@end deftypefn
6773
6774@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6775This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6776enabled/used.
6777The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6778The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6779@end deftypefn
6780
6781@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6782This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6783resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6784the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6785backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6786bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6787of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6788@end deftypefn
6789
7942e47e
RY
6790@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6791This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6792is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6793@end deftypefn
6794
6795@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6796This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6797in its second parameter.
6798@end deftypefn
6799
38f8b050
JR
6800@node Sections
6801@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6802@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6803@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6804
6805An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6806data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6807section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6808section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6809section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6810of sections.
6811
6812@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6813@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6814The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6815is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6816as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6817initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6818They may however depend on command-line flags.
6819
6820@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6821use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6822to be string literals.
6823
6824Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6825section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6826should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6827@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6828
6829You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6830@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6831in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6832@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6833create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6834reuse @code{text_section}.
6835
6836All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6837if the target does not provide them.
6838
6839@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6840A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6841assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6842Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6843@end defmac
6844
6845@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6846If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6847frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6848a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6849@end defmac
6850
6851@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6852If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6853executed functions in the program.
6854@end defmac
6855
6856@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6857A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6858assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6859data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6860@end defmac
6861
6862@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6863If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6864containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6865initialized, writable small data.
6866@end defmac
6867
6868@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6869A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6870assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6871data.
6872@end defmac
6873
6874@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6875If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6876containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6877uninitialized global data. If not defined, and neither
6878@code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} nor @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} are defined,
6879uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6880@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6881used.
6882@end defmac
6883
6884@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6885If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6886containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6887uninitialized, writable small data.
6888@end defmac
6889
6890@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6891If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6892assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6893common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6894@end defmac
6895
6896@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6897If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6898containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6899default is @code{'T'}.
6900@end defmac
6901
6902@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6903If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6904containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6905initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6906not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6907variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6908@end defmac
6909
6910@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6911If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6912containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6913finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6914not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6915variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6916@end defmac
6917
6918@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6919If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6920containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6921part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6922defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6923both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6924@end defmac
6925
6926@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6927If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6928containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6929part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6930defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6931both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6932@end defmac
6933
6934@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6935If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6936via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6937the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6938@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6939to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6940sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6941ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6942registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6943constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6944@end defmac
6945
6946@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6947If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6948variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6949when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6950you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6951they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6952expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6953MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6954require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6955to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6956access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6957@end defmac
6958
6959@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6960If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6961arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6962@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6963and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6964@end defmac
6965
6966@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6967Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6968tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6969section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6970readonly data section is used.
6971
6972This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6973@end defmac
6974
6975@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6976Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6977@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6978of its own that you need to create.
6979
6980GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6981any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6982described below.
6983@end deftypefn
6984
6985@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6986Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6987selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6988should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6989local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6990
6991The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6992is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6993when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6994in read-only sections even in executables.
6995@end deftypefn
6996
6997@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6998Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6999assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7000some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7001requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7002local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7003@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7004
7005The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7006variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7007
7008See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7009@end deftypefn
7010
7011@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7012Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7013for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7014
7015In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7016function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7017it is unlikely to be called.
7018@end defmac
7019
7020@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
7021Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7022and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7023As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7024the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7025
7026The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7027ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7028example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7029Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7030@end deftypefn
7031
7032@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7033Return the readonly data section associated with
7034@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7035The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7036the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7037if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7038otherwise.
7039@end deftypefn
7040
7041@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7042Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7043should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7044constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7045case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7046in bits.
7047
7048The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7049constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7050else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7051@end deftypefn
7052
7053@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7054Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7055by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7056the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7057or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7058hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7059your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7060returns the @var{id} provided.
7061@end deftypefn
7062
7063@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7064Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7065treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7066function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7067
7068The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7069@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7070an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7071rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7072in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7073
7074In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7075a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7076will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7077register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7078rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7079leave it alone.)
7080
7081The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7082that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7083be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7084declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7085declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7086@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7087
7088@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7089The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7090@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7091Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7092encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7093discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7094
7095The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7096in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7097@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7098before overriding it.
7099@end deftypefn
7100
7101@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7102Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7103the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7104may have added.
7105@end deftypefn
7106
7107@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7108Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7109The default version of this hook always returns false.
7110@end deftypefn
7111
7112@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7113Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7114``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7115@end deftypevr
7116
3c5273a9
KT
7117@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7118
38f8b050
JR
7119@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7120Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7121rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7122or executable image).
7123
7124The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7125for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7126currently supported object file formats.
7127@end deftypefn
7128
7129@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7130Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7131The default value is false.
7132@end deftypevr
7133
7134
7135@node PIC
7136@section Position Independent Code
7137@cindex position independent code
7138@cindex PIC
7139
7140This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7141independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7142generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7143@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7144@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7145must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7146when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7147need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7148relative addresses.
7149@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7150@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7151
7152@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7153The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7154data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7155processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7156is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7157pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7158is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7159necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7160when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7161@end defmac
7162
7163@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7164A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7165@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7166the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7167this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7168@end defmac
7169
7170@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7171A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7172operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7173You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7174check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7175check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7176(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7177position independent code.
7178@end defmac
7179
7180@node Assembler Format
7181@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7182
7183This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7184to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7185instructions do.
7186
7187@menu
7188* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7189* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7190* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7191* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7192* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7193 and termination routines.
7194* Macros for Initialization::
7195 Specific macros that control the handling of
7196 initialization and termination routines.
7197* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7198* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7199* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7200* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7201@end menu
7202
7203@node File Framework
7204@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7205@cindex assembler format
7206@cindex output of assembler code
7207
7208@c prevent bad page break with this line
7209This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7210
7211@findex default_file_start
7212@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7213Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7214find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7215by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7216quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7217@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7218lets other target files rely on these variables.
7219@end deftypefn
7220
7221@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7222If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7223printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7224@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7225to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7226definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7227assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7228whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7229
7230The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7231verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7232comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7233@end deftypevr
7234
7235@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7236If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7237for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7238@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7239this to be done. The default is false.
7240@end deftypevr
7241
7242@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7243Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7244to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7245@end deftypefn
7246
7247@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7248Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7249special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7250the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7251should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7252need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7253this function.
7254@end deftypefun
7255
7256@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7257Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7258to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7259nothing.
7260@end deftypefn
7261
7262@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7263Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7264to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7265nothing.
7266@end deftypefn
7267
7268@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7269Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7270unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7271here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7272because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7273nothing.
7274@end deftypefn
7275
7276@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7277A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7278assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7279the end of the line.
7280@end defmac
7281
7282@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7283A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7284statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7285@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7286assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7287that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7288@end defmac
7289
7290@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7291A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7292statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7293@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7294time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7295@end defmac
7296
7297@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7298A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7299which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7300the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7301
7302This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7303for the file format in use is appropriate.
7304@end defmac
7305
b5f5d41d
AS
7306@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7307
38f8b050
JR
7308@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7309A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7310@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7311in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7312the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7313of the filename using this macro.
7314@end defmac
7315
7316@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7317A C statement to output something to the assembler file to handle a
7318@samp{#ident} directive containing the text @var{string}. If this
7319macro is not defined, nothing is output for a @samp{#ident} directive.
7320@end defmac
7321
7322@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7323Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7324should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7325of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7326is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7327this section is associated.
7328@end deftypefn
7329
7330@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7331This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7332@end deftypevr
7333
7334@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7335@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7336This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7337section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7338This is true on most ELF targets.
7339@end deftypevr
7340
7341@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7342Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7343based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7344declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7345null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7346
7347The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7348read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7349need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7350set via @code{__attribute__}.
7351@end deftypefn
7352
7353@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7354Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7355switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7356enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7357It can take the following values:
7358
7359@table @gcctabopt
7360@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7361@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7362
7363@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7364@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7365direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7366default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7367command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7368various different individual optimization passes.
7369
7370@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7371@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7372ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7373target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7374time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7375warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7376wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7377necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7378perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7379switches.
7380
7381@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7382This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7383
7384@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7385This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7386@end table
7387
7388The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7389supported in the future.
7390
7391By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7392provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7393it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7394section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7395provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7396hook.
7397@end deftypefn
7398
7399@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7400This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7401ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7402hook.
7403@end deftypevr
7404
7405@need 2000
7406@node Data Output
7407@subsection Output of Data
7408
7409
7410@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7411@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7412@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7413@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7414@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7415@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7416@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7417@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7418@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7419These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7420of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7421byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7422aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7423@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7424
7425The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7426followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7427the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7428@end deftypevr
7429
7430@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7431The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7432integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7433in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7434function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7435object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7436split the object into smaller parts.
7437
7438The default implementation of this hook will use the
7439@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7440when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7441@end deftypefn
7442
6cbd8875
AS
7443@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7444A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7445can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7446the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7447@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7448
7449If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7450so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7451itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7452return @code{true}.
7453@end deftypefn
7454
38f8b050
JR
7455@defmac OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{fail})
7456A C statement to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that
7457@code{output_addr_const} can't deal with, and output assembly code to
7458@var{stream} corresponding to the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to
7459allow machine-dependent @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7460
7461If @code{OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA} fails to recognize a pattern, it must
7462@code{goto fail}, so that a standard error message is printed. If it
7463prints an error message itself, by calling, for example,
7464@code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just complete normally.
7465@end defmac
7466
7467@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7468A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7469instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7470bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7471@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7472
7473If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7474Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7475@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7476@end defmac
7477
7478@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7479A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7480@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7481is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7482@end defmac
7483
7484@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7485You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7486expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7487pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7488GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7489not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7490pool before the function.
7491@end defmac
7492
7493@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7494A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7495constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7496the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7497be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7498is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7499immediately after this call.
7500
7501If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7502not be defined.
7503@end defmac
7504
7505@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7506A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7507constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7508anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7509
7510The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7511assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7512output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7513@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7514@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7515alignment.
7516
7517The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7518the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7519responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7520Here is how to do this:
7521
7522@smallexample
7523@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7524@end smallexample
7525
7526When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7527@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7528entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7529
7530You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7531@end defmac
7532
7533@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7534A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7535pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7536function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7537obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7538constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7539
7540If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7541define this macro.
7542@end defmac
7543
7544@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7545Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7546used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7547to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7548a line separator uses multiple characters.
7549
7550If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7551the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7552@end defmac
7553
7554@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7555These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7556assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7557default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7558@end deftypevr
7559
7560These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7561of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7562
7563@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7564@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7565@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7566@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7567@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7568@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7569These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7570target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7571the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7572@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7573simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7574@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7575by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7576it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
757732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7578on the host machine.
7579
7580The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7581using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7582machine's memory.
7583@end defmac
7584
7585@node Uninitialized Data
7586@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7587
7588Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7589outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7590
7591@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7592A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7593@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7594@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7595is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7596possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7597other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7598backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7599byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7600equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7601the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7602an ordinary undefined external.
7603
7604Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7605output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7606assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7607
7608This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7609common global variables are output.
7610@end defmac
7611
7612@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7613Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7614separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7615place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7616handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7617as the number of bits.
7618@end defmac
7619
7620@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7621Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7622variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7623is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7624in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7625@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7626the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7627@end defmac
7628
7629@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7630A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7631@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7632@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7633is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7634
7635Try to use function @code{asm_output_bss} defined in @file{varasm.c} when
7636defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7637@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7638before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7639the name, and a newline.
7640
7641There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define either
7642this macro or its aligned counterpart, @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS}.
7643The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7644switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7645You do not need to do both.
7646
7647Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7648non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7649efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7650not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7651common in order to save space in the object file.
7652@end defmac
7653
7654@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7655Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS} except takes the required alignment as a
7656separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7657place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_BSS}, and gives you more flexibility in
7658handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7659as the number of bits.
7660
7661Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7662@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro.
7663@end defmac
7664
7665@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7666A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7667@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7668@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7669is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7670
7671Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7672output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7673assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7674
7675This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7676static variables are output.
7677@end defmac
7678
7679@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7680Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7681separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7682place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7683handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7684as the number of bits.
7685@end defmac
7686
7687@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7688Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7689variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7690is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7691in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7692@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7693the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7694@end defmac
7695
7696@node Label Output
7697@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7698
7699@c prevent bad page break with this line
7700This is about outputting labels.
7701
7702@findex assemble_name
7703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7704A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7705@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7706Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7707output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7708assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7709definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7710@end defmac
7711
135a687e
KT
7712@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7713A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7714@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7715a function.
7716Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7717output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7718assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7719definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7720
7721If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7722usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7723@end defmac
7724
38f8b050
JR
7725@findex assemble_name_raw
7726@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7727Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7728to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7729@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7730that it is more efficient.
7731@end defmac
7732
7733@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7734A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7735size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7736default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7737systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7738
7739Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7740of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7741for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7742macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7743define this macro.
7744@end defmac
7745
7746@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7747A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7748@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7749symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7750If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7751provided.
7752@end defmac
7753
7754@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7755A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7756@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7757the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7758address.
7759
7760If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7761provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7762@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7763the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7764not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7765to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7766@end defmac
7767
7768@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7769A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7770type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7771default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7772systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7773
7774Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7775@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7776custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7777types at all, do not define this macro.
7778@end defmac
7779
7780@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7781A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7782the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7783default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7784the default is not to define this macro.
7785
7786Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7787@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7788custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7789types at all, do not define this macro.
7790@end defmac
7791
7792@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7793A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7794@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7795symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7796that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7797you should not count on this.
7798
7799If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7800definition of this macro is provided.
7801@end defmac
7802
7803@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7804A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7805@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7806function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7807outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7808@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7809@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7810
7811If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7812usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7813
7814You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7815of this macro.
7816@end defmac
7817
7818@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7819A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7820@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7821which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7822function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7823representing the function.
7824
7825If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7826
7827You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7828of this macro.
7829@end defmac
7830
7831@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7832A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7833@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7834initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7835label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7836@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7837
7838If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7839usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7840
7841You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7842@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7843@end defmac
7844
ad78130c 7845@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7846A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7847for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7848target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7849@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7850and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7851will be an internal label.
7852
7853The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7854usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7855
7856You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7857@end deftypefn
7858
7859@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7860A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7861@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7862for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7863
7864If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7865nothing.
7866@end defmac
7867
7868@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7869A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7870once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7871chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7872initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7873something about the size of the object.
7874
7875If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7876nothing.
7877
7878You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7879@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7880@end defmac
7881
7882@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7883This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7884@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7885that is, available for reference from other files.
7886
7887The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7888@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7889@end deftypefn
7890
7891@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7892This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7893@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7894global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7895
7896The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7897@end deftypefn
7898
7899@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7900A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7901@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7902that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7903no other definition is available. Use the expression
7904@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7905itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7906for making that name weak, and a newline.
7907
7908If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7909support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7910macro.
7911@end defmac
7912
7913@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7914Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7915@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7916or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7917should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7918defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7919@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7920to make @var{name} weak.
7921@end defmac
7922
7923@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7924Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7925symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7926declaration of @code{name}.
7927@end defmac
7928
7929@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7930A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7931supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7932
7933If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7934definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7935is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7936@end defmac
7937
7938@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7939A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7940
7941If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7942definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7943this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7944flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7945@end defmac
7946
7947@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7948A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7949public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7950be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7951format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7952section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7953requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7954@end defmac
7955
7956@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7957A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7958semantics.
7959
7960If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7961definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7962definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7963you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7964setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7965be emitted as one-only.
7966@end defmac
7967
7968@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7969This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7970commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7971hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7972@end deftypefn
7973
7974@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7975A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7976that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7977The default is @code{0}.
7978
7979Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7980if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7981will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7982symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7983thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7984(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7985with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7986
7987The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7988targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7989restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7990table of contents.
7991@end defmac
7992
7993@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7994A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7995@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7996symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7997not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7998declaration.
7999
8000This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8001The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8002@end defmac
8003
8004@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
8005This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8006pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8007library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8008@end deftypefn
8009
8010@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
8011This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8012directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8013.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8014@end deftypefn
8015
8016@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8017A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8018@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8019@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8020is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8021systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8022@end defmac
8023
8024@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8025A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8026@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8027will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8028to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8029encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8030@end defmac
8031
8032@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8033A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8034result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8035@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8036This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8037specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8038when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8039being taken.
8040@end defmac
8041
8042@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8043A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8044name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8045
8046It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8047used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8048will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8049
8050It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8051object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8052should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8053beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8054convention your system uses, and follow it.
8055
8056The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8057@end deftypefn
8058
8059@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8060A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8061label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8062@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8063may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8064systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8065bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8066bundles.
8067
8068If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8069used.
8070@end defmac
8071
8072@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8073A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8074is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8075
8076This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8077produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8078with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8079
8080If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8081output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8082@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8083string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8084to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8085@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8086you should know what it does on your machine.)
8087@end defmac
8088
8089@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8090A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8091@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8092@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8093added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8094
8095The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8096produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8097@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8098assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8099macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8100internal static variables in different scopes.
8101
8102Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8103conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8104or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8105between the name and the number will suffice.
8106
8107If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8108which is correct for most systems.
8109@end defmac
8110
8111@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8112A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8113which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8114
8115@findex SET_ASM_OP
8116If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8117correct for most systems.
8118@end defmac
8119
8120@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8121A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8122which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8123to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8124be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8125the tree nodes are available.
8126
8127@findex SET_ASM_OP
8128If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8129correct for most systems.
8130@end defmac
8131
8132@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8133A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8134(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8135of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8136current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8137This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8138@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8139@end defmac
8140
8141@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8142A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8143which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8144@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8145an undefined weak symbol.
8146
8147Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8148@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8149@end defmac
8150
8151@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8152Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8153Objective-C methods.
8154
8155The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8156class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8157the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8158@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8159
8160These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8161the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8162systems define other ways of computing names.
8163
8164@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8165buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8166@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
816750 characters extra.
8168
8169The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8170method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8171@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8172in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8173
8174On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8175macro to provide more human-readable names.
8176@end defmac
8177
8178@defmac ASM_DECLARE_CLASS_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8179A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8180@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8181Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets whose
8182linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8183@end defmac
8184
8185@defmac ASM_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_REFERENCE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8186A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8187@var{stream} commands to declare that the label @var{name} is an
8188unresolved Objective-C class reference. This is only needed for targets
8189whose linkers have special support for NeXT-style runtimes.
8190@end defmac
8191
8192@node Initialization
8193@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8194@cindex initialization routines
8195@cindex termination routines
8196@cindex constructors, output of
8197@cindex destructors, output of
8198
8199The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8200(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8201data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8202to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8203@code{main} is called.
8204
8205Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8206@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8207terminates.
8208
8209To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8210must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8211be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8212system, you need to specify how to do this.
8213
8214There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8215initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8216Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8217
8218@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8219@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8220The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8221initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8222termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8223
8224Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
82250, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8226the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8227pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8228pointer containing zero.
8229
8230Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8231@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8232time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8233list; destructors in forward order.
8234
8235The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8236formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8237aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8238Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8239object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8240the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8241accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8242Termination functions are handled similarly.
8243
8244This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8245@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8246support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8247constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8248and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8249
8250When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8251upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8252support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8253parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8254program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8255
8256@smallexample
8257ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8258@end smallexample
8259
8260The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8261section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8262for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8263files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8264are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8265
8266The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8267compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8268fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8269to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8270of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8271that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8272
8273To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8274macro properly.
8275
8276If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8277@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8278entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8279it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8280after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8281in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8282
8283In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8284two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8285and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8286@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8287entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8288and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8289code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8290the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8291placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8292a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8293@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8294section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8295the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8296the initialization process.
8297
8298The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8299This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8300file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8301this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8302termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8303an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8304pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8305the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8306initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8307via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8308@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8309
8310@ifinfo
8311The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8312customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8313@end ifinfo
8314
8315@node Macros for Initialization
8316@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8317
8318Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8319and termination functions:
8320
8321@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8322If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8323operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8324defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8325using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8326macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8327run the initialization functions.
8328@end defmac
8329
8330@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8331If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8332This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8333on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8334be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8335@end defmac
8336
8337@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8338If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8339the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8340@end defmac
8341
8342@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8343If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8344the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8345@end defmac
8346
8347@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8348If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8349automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8350should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8351the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8352function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8353
8354This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8355shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8356exception tables embedded in the code.
8357@end defmac
8358
8359@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8360If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8361automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8362should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8363the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8364function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8365@end defmac
8366
8367@defmac INVOKE__main
8368If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8369@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8370where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8371useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8372@end defmac
8373
8374@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8375If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8376compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8377of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8378encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8379@end defmac
8380
8381@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8382This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8383collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8384It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8385@end deftypevr
8386
8387@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8388If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8389the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8390
8391Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8392no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8393priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8394otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8395
8396If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8397be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8398target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8399is not defined.
8400@end deftypefn
8401
8402@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8403This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8404functions rather than initialization functions.
8405@end deftypefn
8406
8407If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8408generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8409
8410If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8411constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8412an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8413
8414On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8415@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8416
8417@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8418Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8419object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8420object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8421
8422This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8423part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8424@end defmac
8425
8426@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8427Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8428to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8429@command{nm}.
8430
8431If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8432dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8433these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8434termination functions in shared libraries:
8435@end defmac
8436
8437@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8438Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8439which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{"ldd"} under SunOS 4.
8440@end defmac
8441
8442@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8443Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8444of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8445of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8446from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8447code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8448line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8449@end defmac
8450
8451@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8452Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8453library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8454strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8455constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8456that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8457@end defmac
8458
8459@node Instruction Output
8460@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8461
8462@c prevent bad page break with this line
8463This describes assembler instruction output.
8464
8465@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8466A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8467registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8468register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8469@end defmac
8470
8471@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8472If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8473and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8474registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8475to registers using alternate names.
8476@end defmac
8477
8478@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8479Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8480requires different names for the machine instructions.
8481
8482The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8483assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8484macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8485points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8486written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8487opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8488increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8489so that it will not be output twice.
8490
8491In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8492name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8493that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8494care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8495@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8496
8497@findex recog_data.operand
8498If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8499elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8500
8501If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8502in the usual way.
8503@end defmac
8504
8505@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8506If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8507assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8508they will be output differently.
8509
8510Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8511extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8512elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8513The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8514template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8515by changing the contents of the vector.
8516
8517This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8518file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8519can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8520as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8521syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8522writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8523
8524If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8525@end defmac
8526
8527@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8528If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8529output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8530if necessary.
8531
8532Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8533extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8534elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8535The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8536template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8537by checking the contents of the vector.
8538@end deftypefn
8539
8540@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8541A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8542assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8543RTL expression.
8544
8545@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8546of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8547printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8548the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8549operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8550@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8551@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8552
8553@findex reg_names
8554If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8555The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8556@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8557@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8558
8559When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8560(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8561with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8562@var{code}.
8563@end defmac
8564
8565@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8566A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8567punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8568@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8569punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8570in this way.
8571@end defmac
8572
8573@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8574A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8575assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8576whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8577
8578@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8579On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8580section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8581@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8582@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8583Format}.
8584@end defmac
8585
8586@findex dbr_sequence_length
8587@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8588A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8589been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8590determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8591currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8592or whatever.
8593
8594Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8595reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8596explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8597@end defmac
8598
8599@findex final_sequence
8600Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8601prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8602(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8603found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8604processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8605being output.
8606
8607@findex asm_fprintf
8608@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8609@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8610@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8611@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8612If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8613@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8614@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8615support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8616files can define these macros differently.
8617@end defmac
8618
8619@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8620If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8621statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8622the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8623printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8624statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8625generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8626specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8627The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8628string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8629upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8630@end defmac
8631
8632@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8633If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8634different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8635numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8636first variant.
8637
8638If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8639@smallexample
8640@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8641@end smallexample
8642@noindent
8643in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8644first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8645@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8646@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8647within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8648alternatives within the braces than the value of
8649@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8650
8651If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8652@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8653operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8654
8655Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8656@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8657the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8658@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8659if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8660opcodes or operand order.
8661@end defmac
8662
8663@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8664A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8665which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8666The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8667profiling.
8668@end defmac
8669
8670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8671A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8672which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8673The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8674profiling.
8675@end defmac
8676
8677@node Dispatch Tables
8678@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8679
8680@c prevent bad page break with this line
8681This concerns dispatch tables.
8682
8683@cindex dispatch table
8684@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8685A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8686pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8687@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8688definitions of these labels are output using
8689@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8690way here. For example,
8691
8692@smallexample
8693fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8694 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8695@end smallexample
8696
8697You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8698dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8699will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8700@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8701mode and flags can be read.
8702@end defmac
8703
8704@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8705This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8706in a dispatch table are absolute.
8707
8708The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8709@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8710a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8711definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8712For example,
8713
8714@smallexample
8715fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8716@end smallexample
8717@end defmac
8718
8719@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8720Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8721specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8722@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8723jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8724@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8725
8726This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8727for the table.
8728
8729If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8730@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8731@end defmac
8732
8733@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8734Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8735jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8736after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8737the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8738@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8739of the preceding label.
8740
8741If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8742the jump-table.
8743@end defmac
8744
8745@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8746This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8747should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8748should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8749function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8750The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8751exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8752true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8753
8754The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8755@end deftypefn
8756
8757@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8758This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8759It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8760to be broken up according to function.
8761
8762The default is that no label is emitted.
8763@end deftypefn
8764
a68b5e52
RH
8765@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8766
38f8b050
JR
8767@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8768This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8769given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8770returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8771@end deftypefn
8772
3bc6b3e6
RH
8773@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8774
38f8b050
JR
8775@node Exception Region Output
8776@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8777
8778@c prevent bad page break with this line
8779
8780This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8781region.
8782
8783@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8784If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8785exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8786provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8787@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8788
8789You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8790unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8791@end defmac
8792
8793@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8794If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8795data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8796might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8797collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8798
8799Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8800also defined.
8801@end defmac
8802
8803@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8804Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8805information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8806runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8807and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8808@end defmac
8809
8810@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8811An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8812that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8813@end defmac
8814
8815@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8816Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8817information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8818Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
f0a0390e
RH
8819@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either @code{UNALIGNED_INT_ASM_OP}
8820or @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}), GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
8821@end defmac
38f8b050 8822
f0a0390e
RH
8823@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8824This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8825by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8826should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8827@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8828should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8829information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8830
f0a0390e
RH
8831A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8832This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8833default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8834
f0a0390e
RH
8835Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
8836not depend on anything except command-line switches. In particular, the
8837setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8838macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8839depending on this setting.
8840
8841The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8842@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
8843@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}.
8844@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8845
8846@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8847This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
8848tables even when exceptions are not used.
8849@end deftypevr
8850
8851@defmac MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS
8852This macro need only be defined if @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} is
8853runtime-variable. In that case, @file{except.h} cannot correctly
8854determine the corresponding definition of @code{MUST_USE_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS},
8855so the target must provide it directly.
8856@end defmac
8857
8858@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8859Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8860should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8861instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8862@end defmac
8863
8864@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8865This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8866function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8867@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8868alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8869minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8870the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8871@end defmac
8872
8873@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8874Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8875end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8876Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8877true otherwise.
8878@end deftypevr
8879
8880@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8881Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8882represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8883register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8884locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8885register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8886If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8887@end deftypefn
8888
8889@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8890If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8891multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8892sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8893It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8894filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8895@var{address} is the address of the table.
8896@end deftypefn
8897
8898@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8899This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8900the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8901if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8902reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8903@end deftypefn
8904
8905@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8906This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8907based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8908the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8909running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8910@end deftypevr
8911
8912@node Alignment Output
8913@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8914
8915@c prevent bad page break with this line
8916This describes commands for alignment.
8917
8918@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8919The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8920a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8921
8922This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8923to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8924define the macro.
8925
8926Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8927to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8928@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8929selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8930@end defmac
8931
ad0c4c36
DD
8932@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8933The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8934@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8935@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8936@end deftypefn
8937
38f8b050
JR
8938@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8939The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8940a @code{BARRIER}.
8941
8942This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8943to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8944define the macro.
8945@end defmac
8946
ad0c4c36
DD
8947@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8948The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8949@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8950@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8951@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8952
8953@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8954The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8955a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8956
8957This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8958to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8959define the macro.
8960
8961Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8962to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8963@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8964selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8965@end defmac
8966
ad0c4c36
DD
8967@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8968The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8969@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8970defined.
8971@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8972
8973@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8974The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8975If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8976the maximum of the specified values is used.
8977
8978Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8979to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8980@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8981selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8982@end defmac
8983
ad0c4c36
DD
8984@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8985The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8986to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8987is defined.
8988@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8989
8990@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8991A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8992instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8993Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8994expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8995@end defmac
8996
8997@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8998Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8999text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9000This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9001produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9002section.
9003@end defmac
9004
9005@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9006A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9007command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9008@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9009@end defmac
9010
9011@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9012Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9013for padding, if necessary.
9014@end defmac
9015
9016@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9017A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9018command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9019@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9020satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9021a C expression of type @code{int}.
9022@end defmac
9023
9024@need 3000
9025@node Debugging Info
9026@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9027
9028@c prevent bad page break with this line
9029This describes how to specify debugging information.
9030
9031@menu
9032* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9033* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9034* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9035* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9036* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9037* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9038@end menu
9039
9040@node All Debuggers
9041@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9042
9043@c prevent bad page break with this line
9044These macros affect all debugging formats.
9045
9046@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9047A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9048register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9049of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9050some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9051versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9052compiler and another for DBX@.
9053
9054If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9055used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9056consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9057Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9058expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9059
9060If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9061does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9062redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9063@end defmac
9064
9065@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9066A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9067variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9068computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9069gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9070that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9071for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9072@option{-g} options is used.
9073@end defmac
9074
9075@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9076A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9077having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9078@var{offset}.
9079@end defmac
9080
9081@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9082A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9083produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9084this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9085debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9086@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9087@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9088
9089When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9090value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9091exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9092value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9093defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9094
9095The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9096user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9097@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9098@end defmac
9099
9100@node DBX Options
9101@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9102
9103@c prevent bad page break with this line
9104These are specific options for DBX output.
9105
9106@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9107Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9108in response to the @option{-g} option.
9109@end defmac
9110
9111@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9112Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9113in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9114@end defmac
9115
9116@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9117Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9118GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9119debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9120macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9121if there is any occasion to.
9122@end defmac
9123
9124@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9125Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9126in the text section.
9127@end defmac
9128
9129@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9130A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9131use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9132If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9133applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9134@end defmac
9135
9136@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9137A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9138use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9139value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9140@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9141information format.
9142@end defmac
9143
9144@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9145A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9146use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9147name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9148macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9152Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9153@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9154describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9155On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9156@end defmac
9157
9158@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9159A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9160continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9161exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9162operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9163must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9164with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9165defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9166@end defmac
9167
9168@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9169Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9170the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9171a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9172constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9173if backslash is correct for your system.
9174@end defmac
9175
9176@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9177Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9178outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9179variable.
9180@end defmac
9181
9182@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9183The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9184for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9185@end defmac
9186
9187@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9188The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9189for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9190provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9191@end defmac
9192
9193@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9194The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9195for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9196``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9197@end defmac
9198
9199@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9200The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9201passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9202do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9203@end defmac
9204
9205@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9206Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9207arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9208in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9209code.
9210@end defmac
9211
9212@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9213Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9214the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9215relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9216an absolute address.
9217@end defmac
9218
9219@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9220Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9221the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9222start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9223@end defmac
9224
9225@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9226Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9227@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9228macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9229number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9230generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9231number for a type number.
9232@end defmac
9233
9234@node DBX Hooks
9235@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9236
9237@c prevent bad page break with this line
9238These are hooks for DBX format.
9239
9240@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9241Define this macro to say how to output to @var{stream} the debugging
9242information for the start of a scope level for variable names. The
9243argument @var{name} is the name of an assembler symbol (for use with
9244@code{assemble_name}) whose value is the address where the scope begins.
9245@end defmac
9246
9247@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_RBRAC (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9248Like @code{DBX_OUTPUT_LBRAC}, but for the end of a scope level.
9249@end defmac
9250
9251@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NFUN (@var{stream}, @var{lscope_label}, @var{decl})
9252Define this macro if the target machine requires special handling to
9253output an @code{N_FUN} entry for the function @var{decl}.
9254@end defmac
9255
9256@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9257A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9258number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9259@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9260invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9261unique labels in the assembly output.
9262
9263This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9264if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9265@end defmac
9266
9267@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9268Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9269@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9270On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9271disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9272@end defmac
9273
9274@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9275Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9276extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9277feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9278@end defmac
9279
9280@node File Names and DBX
9281@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9282
9283@c prevent bad page break with this line
9284This describes file names in DBX format.
9285
9286@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9287A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9288@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9289file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9290This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9291
9292This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9293for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9294
9295It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9296text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9297to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9298@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9299@end defmac
9300
9301@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9302Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9303of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9304the beginning of the file.
9305@end defmac
9306
9307@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9308Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9309that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9310an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9311@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9312@end defmac
9313
9314@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9315A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9316compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9317written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9318
9319If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9320of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9321@end defmac
9322
9323@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9324Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9325@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9326the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9327whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9328@end defmac
9329
9330@need 2000
9331@node SDB and DWARF
9332@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9333
9334@c prevent bad page break with this line
9335Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9336
9337@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9338Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9339for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9340@end defmac
9341
9342@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9343Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9344debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9345
9346@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9347Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9348be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9349value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9350@end deftypefn
9351
9352To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9353define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9354@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9355prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9356as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9357@end defmac
9358
9359@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9360Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9361Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9362(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9363exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9364how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9365@end defmac
9366
f0a0390e
RH
9367@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9368This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9369unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9370@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9371return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9372
9373A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9374is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9375
9376A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9377This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9378@end deftypefn
9379
38f8b050
JR
9380@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9381Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9382line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9383tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9384@end defmac
9385
9730bc27
TT
9386@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9387
38f8b050
JR
9388@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9389A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9390@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9391@end defmac
9392
9393@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9394A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9395between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9396slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9397@end defmac
9398
9399@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9400A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9401section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9402given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9403@end defmac
9404
9405@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9406A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9407reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9408@end defmac
9409
9410@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9411A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9412the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9413is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9414is referenced by a function.
9415@end defmac
9416
9417@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9418If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9419reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9420@end deftypefn
9421
9422@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9423Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9424SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9425macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9426not define them yourself.
9427@end defmac
9428
9429@defmac SDB_DELIM
9430Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9431SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9432delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9433a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9434required.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9438Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9439union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9440allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9441it.
9442@end defmac
9443
9444@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9445Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9446enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9447assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9448@end defmac
9449
9450@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9451A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9452number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9453@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9454@end defmac
9455
9456@need 2000
9457@node VMS Debug
9458@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9459
9460@c prevent bad page break with this line
9461Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9462
9463@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9464Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9465in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9466is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9467@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9468behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9469@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9470@end defmac
9471
9472@node Floating Point
9473@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9474@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9475@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9476
9477While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9478there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9479means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9480in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9481doing the compilation.
9482
9483Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9484range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9485the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9486safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9487the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9488emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9489target floating point formats are identical.
9490
9491The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9492use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9493floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9494their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9495
9496@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9497The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9498machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9499array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9500quantity.
9501@end defmac
9502
9503@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9504Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9505floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9506@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9507@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9508@end deftypefn
9509
9510@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9511Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9512@end deftypefn
9513
9514@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9515Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9516@end deftypefn
9517
9518@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9519Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9520@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9521@end deftypefn
9522
9523@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9524Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9525representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9526decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9527defined by the C language for both.
9528@end deftypefn
9529
9530@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9531Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9532@end deftypefn
9533
9534@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9535Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9536@end deftypefn
9537
9538@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9539Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9540@end deftypefn
9541
9542@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9543Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9544@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9545variable).
9546
9547The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9548following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9549@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9550
9551If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9552target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9553@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9554@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9555@end deftypefn
9556
9557@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9558Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9559@end deftypefn
9560
9561@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9562Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9563@end deftypefn
9564
9565@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_TRUNCATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{mode}, enum machine_mode @var{x})
9566Truncates the floating point value @var{x} to fit in @var{mode}. The
9567return value is still a full-size @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, but it has an
9568appropriate bit pattern to be output as a floating constant whose
9569precision accords with mode @var{mode}.
9570@end deftypefn
9571
9572@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9573Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9574which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9575integral, it is truncated.
9576@end deftypefn
9577
9578@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9579Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9580into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9581value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9582@end deftypefn
9583
9584@node Mode Switching
9585@section Mode Switching Instructions
9586@cindex mode switching
9587The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9588
9589@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9590Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9591switching in an optimizing compilation.
9592
9593For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9594floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9595the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9596operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9597purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9598be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9599or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9600
9601You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9602which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9603return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9604If you define this macro, you also have to define
9605@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9606@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9607@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9608are optional.
9609@end defmac
9610
9611@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9612If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9613initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9614N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9615of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9616The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9617zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9618entity in question.
9619In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9620represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9621switch is needed / supplied.
9622@end defmac
9623
9624@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9625@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9626@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9627return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9628@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9629be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9630@end defmac
9631
9632@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{mode}, @var{insn})
9633If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
9634mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9635different from the incoming mode).
9636@end defmac
9637
9638@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9639If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9640mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9641@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9642is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9643@end defmac
9644
9645@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9646If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9647mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9648@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9649is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9650@end defmac
9651
9652@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9653This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96540 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9655lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9656for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9657(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9658@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9659@end defmac
9660
9661@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9662Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9663@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9664the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9665@end defmac
9666
9667@node Target Attributes
9668@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9669@cindex target attributes
9670@cindex machine attributes
9671@cindex attributes, target-specific
9672
9673Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9674These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9675be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9676
9677@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9678If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9679attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9680specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9681entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9682take.
9683@end deftypevr
9684
9685@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9686If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9687machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9688given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9689subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9690false for all machine-specific attributes.
9691@end deftypefn
9692
9693@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9694If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9695@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9696and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9697generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9698supposed always to be compatible.
9699@end deftypefn
9700
9701@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9702If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9703the newly defined @var{type}.
9704@end deftypefn
9705
9706@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9707Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9708handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9709@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9710that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9711function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9712merging.
9713@end deftypefn
9714
9715@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9716Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9717handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9718@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9719@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9720when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9721attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9722call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9723
9724@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9725If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9726for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9727@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9728will then define a function called
9729@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9730the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9731add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9732to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9733@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9734@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9735@end deftypefn
9736
9737@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9738
9739@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9740Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9741@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9742default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9743@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9744of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9745on this implementation detail.
9746@end defmac
9747
9748@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9749Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9750when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9751wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9752the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9753created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9754for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9755shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9756the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9757attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9758needed.
9759@end deftypefn
9760
9761@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9762@cindex inlining
9763This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9764into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9765attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9766target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9767@end deftypefn
9768
9769@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9770This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9771it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9772options for the current function that might be different than the
9773options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9774@code{true} if the options are valid.
9775
9776The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9777the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9778@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9779@end deftypefn
9780
9781@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9782This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9783in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9784options.
9785@xref{Option file format}.
9786@end deftypefn
9787
9788@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9789This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9790information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9791function specific options.
9792@end deftypefn
9793
9794@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9795This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9796information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9797function specific options.
9798@end deftypefn
9799
56cb42ea 9800@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9801This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9802set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9803input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9804@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9805@end deftypefn
9806
9807@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9808Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9809a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9810@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9811once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9812
9813Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9814@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9815
9816If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9817changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9818@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9819@end deftypefn
9820
9821@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9822This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9823cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9824default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9825specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9826@end deftypefn
9827
9828@node Emulated TLS
9829@section Emulating TLS
9830@cindex Emulated TLS
9831
9832For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9833specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9834used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9835configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9836the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9837layer.
9838
9839The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9840object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9841which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9842address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9843
9844@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9845Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9846object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9847emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9848@end deftypevr
9849
9850@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9851Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9852program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9853initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9854have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9855registration function to be used.
9856@end deftypevr
9857
9858@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9859Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9860be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9861any section.
9862@end deftypevr
9863
9864@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9865Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9866placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9867section.
9868@end deftypevr
9869
9870@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9871Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9872The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9873@end deftypevr
9874
9875@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9876Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9877default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9878@end deftypevr
9879
9880@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9881Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9882object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9883@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9884@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9885for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9886@end deftypefn
9887
9888@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9889Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9890TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9891is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9892initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9893@end deftypefn
9894
9895@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9896Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9897fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9898single objects. The default is false.
9899@end deftypevr
9900
9901@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9902Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9903may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9904@end deftypevr
9905
9906@node MIPS Coprocessors
9907@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9908@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9909
9910The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9911coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9912accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9913and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9914
9915@smallexample
9916 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9917 unsigned int d;
9918
9919 d = cp0count + 3;
9920@end smallexample
9921
9922(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9923names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9924overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9925
9926Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9927be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9928later in the function.
9929
9930Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9931the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9932floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9933
9934There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9935you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9936
9937@defmac ALL_COP_ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9938A comma-separated list (with leading comma) of pairs describing the
9939alternate names of coprocessor registers. The format of each entry should be
9940@smallexample
9941@{ @var{alternatename}, @var{register_number}@}
9942@end smallexample
9943Default: empty.
9944@end defmac
9945
9946@node PCH Target
9947@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9948@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9949
9950@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9951This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9952@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9953@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9954@end deftypefn
9955
9956@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9957This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9958compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9959if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9960be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9961
9962@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9963when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9964It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9965compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9966
9967The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9968suitable for most targets.
9969@end deftypefn
9970
9971@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9972If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9973@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9974of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9975@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9976value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9977@end deftypefn
9978
9979@node C++ ABI
9980@section C++ ABI parameters
9981@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9982
9983@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9984Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9985These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9986default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9987@end deftypefn
9988
9989@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9990This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9991@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9992@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9993@end deftypefn
9994
9995@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9996This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9997whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9998known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9999@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10000IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10001@end deftypefn
10002
10003@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
10004This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10005array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10006@end deftypefn
10007
10008@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
10009If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10010class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10011will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10012to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10013modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10014backend's targeted operating system.
10015@end deftypefn
10016
10017@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
10018This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10019the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10020@code{false}.
10021@end deftypefn
10022
10023@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
10024This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10025which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10026table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10027Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10028the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10029some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10030method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10031@end deftypefn
10032
10033@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
10034
10035@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
10036This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10037similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10038external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10039classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10040unit will not be COMDAT.
10041@end deftypefn
10042
10043@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
10044This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10045the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10046be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10047@end deftypefn
10048
10049@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10050This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10051should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10052is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10053@end deftypefn
10054
10055@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10056This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10057in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10058destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10059shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10060unloaded. The default is to return false.
10061@end deftypefn
10062
10063@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10064
10065@node Named Address Spaces
10066@section Adding support for named address spaces
10067@cindex named address spaces
10068
10069The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10070standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10071support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10072processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10073GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10074address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10075spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10076@code{const} type attributes.
10077
10078Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10079pointers to the generic address space.
10080
10081For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10082to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10083processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10084issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10085local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10086address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10087@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10088always 32 bits).
10089
10090Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10091range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10092address space.
10093
10094To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10095the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10096the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10097named address space #1:
10098@smallexample
10099#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10100c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10101@end smallexample
10102
10103@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10104Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10105@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10106The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10107generic address space only.
10108@end deftypefn
10109
10110@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10111Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10112@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10113The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10114generic address space only.
10115@end deftypefn
10116
10117@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10118Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10119with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10120hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10121except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10122version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10123@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10124target hooks for the given address space.
10125@end deftypefn
10126
10127@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10128Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10129@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10130parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10131finished. This target hook is the same as the
10132@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10133explicit named address space support.
10134@end deftypefn
10135
10136@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10137Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10138with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10139hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10140except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10141@end deftypefn
10142
10143@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10144Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10145contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10146a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10147will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10148arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10149converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10150@end deftypefn
10151
10152@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10153Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10154@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10155space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10156to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10157guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10158as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10159@end deftypefn
10160
10161@node Misc
10162@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10163@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10164
10165@c prevent bad page break with this line
10166Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10167
10168@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10169Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10170has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10171conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10172blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10173set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10174to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10175@end defmac
10176
10177@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10178Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10179has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10180conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10181blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10182set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10183to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10184@end defmac
10185
10186@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10187An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10188elements of a jump-table should have.
10189@end defmac
10190
10191@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10192Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10193when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10194it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10195To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10196make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10197The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10198flags can be updated.
10199@end defmac
10200
10201@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10202Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10203should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10204jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10205contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10206is in effect.
10207@end defmac
10208
10209@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10210This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10211is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10212The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10213five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10214@end deftypefn
10215
10216@defmac CASE_USE_BIT_TESTS
10217Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate whether C switch
10218statements may be implemented by a sequence of bit tests. This is
10219advantageous on processors that can efficiently implement left shift
10220of 1 by the number of bits held in a register, but inappropriate on
10221targets that would require a loop. By default, this macro returns
10222@code{true} if the target defines an @code{ashlsi3} pattern, and
10223@code{false} otherwise.
10224@end defmac
10225
10226@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10227Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10228smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10229Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10230@end defmac
10231
10232@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10233Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10234memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10235bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10236zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10237of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10238insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10239@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10240
10241This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10242greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10243value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10244@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10245define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10246
10247You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10248the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10249of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10250when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10251integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10252
10253You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10254mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10255@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10256is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10257@end defmac
10258
10259@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10260Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10261extends.
10262@end defmac
10263
10264@defmac FIXUNS_TRUNC_LIKE_FIX_TRUNC
10265Define this macro if the same instructions that convert a floating
10266point number to a signed fixed point number also convert validly to an
10267unsigned one.
10268@end defmac
10269
10270@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10271When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10272divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10273the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10274that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10275of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10276has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10277@end deftypefn
10278
10279@defmac MOVE_MAX
10280The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10281between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10282@end defmac
10283
10284@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10285The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10286between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10287is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10288constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10289at run-time.
10290@end defmac
10291
10292@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10293A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10294actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10295of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10296this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10297a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10298truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10299instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10300include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10301also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10302arguments to bit-field instructions.
10303
10304If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10305position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10306instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10307
10308However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10309only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10310bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10311such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10312the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10313
10314You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10315@end defmac
10316
10317@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10318@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10319This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10320deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10321@xref{shift patterns}.
10322
10323On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10324shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10325equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10326this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10327otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10328particular behavior is guaranteed.
10329
10330Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10331@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10332that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10333
10334The default implementation of this function returns
10335@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10336and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10337@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10338nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10339by overriding it.
10340@end deftypefn
10341
10342@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10343A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10344``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10345bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10346operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10347
10348On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10349
10350@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10351@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10352When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10353modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10354If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10355such cases may improve things.
10356@end defmac
10357
10358@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10359The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10360are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10361@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10362sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10363otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10364representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10365@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10366@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10367@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10368widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10369
10370Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10371value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10372as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10373@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10374
10375Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10376describe two related properties. If you define
10377@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10378to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10379extension.
10380
10381In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10382@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10383@code{mode}.
10384@end deftypefn
10385
10386@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10387A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10388with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10389(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10390apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10391comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10392
10393A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10394comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10395and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10396which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10397true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10398operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10399@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10400@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10401the compiler.
10402
10403If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10404generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10405replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10406the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10407For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10408@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10409@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10410expression
10411
10412@smallexample
10413(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10414@end smallexample
10415
10416@noindent
10417can be converted to
10418
10419@smallexample
10420(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10421@end smallexample
10422
10423@noindent
10424where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10425tested into the sign bit.
10426
10427There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10428for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10429but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10430are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10431perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10432comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10433
10434Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10435from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10436choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10437to be used:
10438
10439@itemize @bullet
10440@item
10441Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10442@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10443``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10444comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10445combine the normalization with other operations.
10446
10447@item
10448For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10449slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10450other machines.
10451
10452@item
10453As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10454exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10455others.
10456
10457@item
10458Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10459@end itemize
10460
10461Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10462@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10463instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10464those cases, e.g., one matching
10465
10466@smallexample
10467(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10468@end smallexample
10469
10470Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10471condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10472@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10473machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10474and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10475@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10476@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptizer can be used to
10477find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10478
10479If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10480not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10481instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10482@end defmac
10483
10484@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10485A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10486returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10487Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10488floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10489this macro.
10490@end defmac
10491
10492@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10493A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10494for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10495mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10496this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10497return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10498this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10499@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10500the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10501given mode.
10502@end defmac
10503
10504@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10505@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10506A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10507for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10508A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10509If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10510evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10511entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10512the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10513In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10514this value.
10515
10516If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10517@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10518
10519This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10520relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10521is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10522to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10523
10524Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10525and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10526visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10527to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10528breaking the API@.
10529@end defmac
10530
10531@defmac Pmode
10532An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10533this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10534pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10535On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10536modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10537
10538The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10539@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10540@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10541to @code{Pmode}.
10542@end defmac
10543
10544@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10545An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10546being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10547where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10548@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10549size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10550as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10551@end defmac
10552
10553@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10554In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10555constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10556hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10557where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10558strict conformance to the C Standard.
10559
10560Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10561convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10562files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10563@end defmac
10564
10565@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10566Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10567This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10568C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10569@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10570@end defmac
10571
10572@findex #pragma
10573@findex pragma
10574@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10575Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10576If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10577@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10578for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10579setup required for the pragmas.
10580
10581The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10582other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10583definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10584
10585If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10586defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10587
10588Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10589@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10590silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10591@end defmac
10592
10593@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10594@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10595
10596Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10597@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10598@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10599pragma of the form
10600
10601@smallexample
10602#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10603@end smallexample
10604
10605@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10606@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10607routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10608on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10609@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10610callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10611a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10612arguments of pragmas registered with
10613@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10614pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10615
10616Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10617compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10618other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10619to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10620building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10621variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10622target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10623the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10624code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10625rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10626how to build this object file.
10627@end deftypefun
10628
10629@findex #pragma
10630@findex pragma
10631@defmac HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA
10632Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want the System V style
10633pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(<n>)} and @samp{#pragma weak <name>
10634[=<value>]} to be supported by gcc.
10635
10636The pack pragma specifies the maximum alignment (in bytes) of fields
10637within a structure, in much the same way as the @samp{__aligned__} and
10638@samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A pack value of zero resets
10639the behavior to the default.
10640
10641A subtlety for Microsoft Visual C/C++ style bit-field packing
10642(e.g.@: -mms-bitfields) for targets that support it:
10643When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
10644of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
10645bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
10646and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
10647chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
10648size is allocated).
10649
10650If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
10651the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
10652used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
10653precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
10654may affect its placement.
10655
10656The weak pragma only works if @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK} and
10657@code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} are defined. If enabled it allows the creation
10658of specifically named weak labels, optionally with a value.
10659@end defmac
10660
10661@findex #pragma
10662@findex pragma
10663@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_PUSH_POP
10664Define this macro (to a value of 1) if you want to support the Win32
10665style pragmas @samp{#pragma pack(push[,@var{n}])} and @samp{#pragma
10666pack(pop)}. The @samp{pack(push,[@var{n}])} pragma specifies the maximum
10667alignment (in bytes) of fields within a structure, in much the same way as
10668the @samp{__aligned__} and @samp{__packed__} @code{__attribute__}s do. A
10669pack value of zero resets the behavior to the default. Successive
10670invocations of this pragma cause the previous values to be stacked, so
10671that invocations of @samp{#pragma pack(pop)} will return to the previous
10672value.
10673@end defmac
10674
10675@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10676Define this macro, as well as
10677@code{HANDLE_SYSV_PRAGMA}, if macros should be expanded in the
10678arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10679@end defmac
10680
10681@hook TARGET_HANDLE_PRAGMA_EXTERN_PREFIX
10682
10683@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10684If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10685the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10686This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10687@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10688@end defmac
10689
10690@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10691Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10692identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10693not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10694there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10695@end defmac
10696
10697@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10698Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10699@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10700G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10701@samp{.} is used instead.
10702@end defmac
10703
10704@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10705Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10706@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10707have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10708are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10709@end defmac
10710
10711@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10712Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10713delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10714even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10715@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10716every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10717or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10718you should define this macro.
10719
10720You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10721@end defmac
10722
10723@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10724Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10725delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10726even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10727@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10728some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10729are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10730define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10731instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10732slot of @var{insn}.
10733
10734You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10735@end defmac
10736
10737@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10738Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10739global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10740symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10741instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10742from shared libraries (DLLs).
10743
10744You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10745@end defmac
10746
10747@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10748This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10749any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10750It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10751clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10752corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10753clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10754@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10755for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10756@end deftypefn
10757
10758@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10759Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10760in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10761@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10762separate math library.
10763
d9d16a19 10764You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10765@end defmac
10766
10767@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10768Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10769specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10770
10771You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10772is wrong.
10773@end defmac
10774
10775@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10776Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10777functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10778Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10779to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10780if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10781for cross-profiling.
10782@end defmac
10783
10784@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10785
10786A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10787conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10788@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
107891 if it does use cc0.
10790@end defmac
10791
10792@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10793Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10794conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10795@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10796contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10797and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10798then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10799@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10800@end defmac
10801
10802@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10803Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10804if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10805@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10806being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10807@end defmac
10808
10809@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10810A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10811be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10812a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10813about the currently processed blocks.
10814@end defmac
10815
10816@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10817A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10818converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10819can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10820to by @var{ce_info}.
10821@end defmac
10822
10823@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10824A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10825converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10826can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10827to by @var{ce_info}.
10828@end defmac
10829
10830@defmac IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS (@var{ce_info})
10831A C expression to initialize any extra fields in a @code{struct ce_if_block}
10832structure, which are defined by the @code{IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10833@end defmac
10834
10835@defmac IFCVT_EXTRA_FIELDS
10836If defined, it should expand to a set of field declarations that will be
10837added to the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure. These should be initialized
10838by the @code{IFCVT_INIT_EXTRA_FIELDS} macro.
10839@end defmac
10840
10841@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10842If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10843instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10844just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10845
10846The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10847it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10848laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10849Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10850
10851You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10852definition is null.
10853@end deftypefn
10854
10855@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10856Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10857that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10858necessary setup.
10859
10860Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10861instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10862they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10863instructions or prefetch instructions).
10864
10865To create a built-in function, call the function
10866@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10867which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
10868up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes} and @code{build_common_tree_nodes_2};
10869only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10870@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10871@end deftypefn
10872
10873@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10874Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10875that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10876builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10877If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10878if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10879If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10880@code{error_mark_node}.
10881@end deftypefn
10882
10883@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10884
10885Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10886@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10887function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10888convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10889@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10890@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10891ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10892built-in function.
10893@end deftypefn
10894
d66f5459 10895@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10896Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10897was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10898@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10899implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10900declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10901arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10902complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10903another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10904@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10905@end deftypefn
10906
08914aaa 10907@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10908Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10909@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10910built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10911the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10912The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10913call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10914@end deftypefn
10915
10916@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10917
10918Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10919low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10920could not be applied.
10921
10922Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10923instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10924the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10925By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10926loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10927@end deftypefn
10928
10929@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10930
10931Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10932Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10933@var{branch2} is possible.
10934
10935On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10936filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10937may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10938@end defmac
10939
10940@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10941This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10942Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10943PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10944of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10945@end deftypefn
10946
10947@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10948
10949When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10950register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10951to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10952it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10953is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10954that had its initial value copied by using
10955@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10956Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10957to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10958the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10959@code{MEM}.
10960If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10961it might decide to use another register anyways.
10962You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10963that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10964register in question will not be clobbered.
10965The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10966allocation.
10967@end deftypefn
10968
10969@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10970This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10971@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10972this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10973@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10974to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10975passed along.
10976@end deftypefn
10977
10978@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
10979The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
10980context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10981the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10982per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10983attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10984The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10985and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10986and is returning to processing at the top level.
10987The default hook function does nothing.
10988
10989GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10990some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10991situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10992or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10993@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10994outside of any function scope.
10995@end deftypefn
10996
10997@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10998Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10999files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11000use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11001@end defmac
11002
11003@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11004Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11005automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11006do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11007executable files.
11008@end defmac
11009
11010@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11011If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11012specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11013Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11014object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11015lists.
11016@end defmac
11017
11018@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11019Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11020method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11021must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11022For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11023the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11024defined as this expression:
11025
11026@smallexample
11027build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11028 build_tree_list
11029 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11030 NULL))
11031@end smallexample
11032@end defmac
11033
11034@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
11035This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11036instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11037every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11038reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11039
11040@smallexample
11041static bool
11042cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11043@{
11044 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11045@}
11046@end smallexample
11047@end deftypefn
11048
11049@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
11050This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11051optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11052usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11053re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11054to inter-block scheduling.
11055@end deftypefn
11056
11057@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
11058Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11059registers
11060that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11061returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11062that all target registers in the class returned by
11063@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11064saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11065epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11066true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11067to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11068to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11069@end deftypefn
11070
11071@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
11072This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11073This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11074modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11075@end deftypefn
11076
11077@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
11078This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11079should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11080the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11081the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11082is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11083number of memory accesses.
11084@end deftypefn
11085
11086@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11087If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11088that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11089that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11090constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11091more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11092system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11093The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11094@end defmac
11095
11096@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11097This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11098target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11099are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11100The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11101@end deftypefn
11102
11103@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11104This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11105target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11106indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11107@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11108@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11109@end deftypefn
11110
11111@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11112This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11113The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11114systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11115that are different from @option{-I}.
11116@end deftypefn
11117
11118@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11119This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11120for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11121@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11122functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11123@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11124@end defmac
11125
11126@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11127If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11128target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11129option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11130@end defmac
11131
11132@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11133If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11134@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11135@end defmac
11136
11137@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11138If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11139target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11140default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11141@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11142@end defmac
11143
11144@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11145If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11146@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11147@end defmac
11148
11149@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11150If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11151routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11152and scanf formatter settings.
11153@end defmac
11154
11155@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11156If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11157guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11158main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11159important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11160many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11161``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11162and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11163@end deftypevr
11164
11165@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11166If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11167illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11168with prototype @var{typelist}.
11169@end deftypefn
11170
11171@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11172If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11173invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11174if validity should be determined by the front end.
11175@end deftypefn
11176
11177@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11178If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11179invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11180@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11181if validity should be determined by the front end.
11182@end deftypefn
11183
11184@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11185If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11186invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11187and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11188the front end.
11189@end deftypefn
11190
11191@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11192If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11193invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11194or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11195the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11196@end deftypefn
11197
11198@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11199If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11200invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11201or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11202the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11203@end deftypefn
11204
11205@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
11206If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11207@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11208analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11209front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11210target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11211This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11212@end deftypefn
11213
11214@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
11215If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11216@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11217or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11218This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11219conversion rules.
11220This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11221@end deftypefn
11222
11223@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11224This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11225classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11226SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11227@end defmac
11228
11229@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11230This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11231NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11232@end defmac
11233
11234@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11235Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11236to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11237call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11238and the associated definitions of those functions.
11239@end defmac
11240
11241@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11242Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11243necessary.
11244@end deftypefn
11245
11246@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11247This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11248different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11249argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11250is needed.
11251@end deftypefn
11252
11253@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11254When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11255arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11256stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11257debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11258@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11259cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11260to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11261false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11262@end deftypefn
11263
11264@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11265On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11266a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11267is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11268is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11269subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11270the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11271available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11272constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11273down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11274@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11275accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11276value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11277MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11278@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11279is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr